Mercedes Benz Automobile 2001 CLK 320 User Manual

CLK Cabriolet  
Operator’s Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Our company and staff congratulate you on the purchase of your new Mercedes-Benz.  
Your selection of our product is a demonstration of your trust in our company name. Further, it exemplifies your desire  
to own an automobile that will be as easy as possible to operate and provide years of service.  
Your Mercedes-Benz represents the efforts of many skilled engineers and craftsmen. To ensure your pleasure of  
ownership, and for your safety and that of your passengers, we ask you to make a small investment of your time:  
Please read this manual carefully before putting it aside. Then return it to your vehicle where it will be handy for  
your reference.  
Please abide by the recommendations contained in this manual. They are designed to acquaint you with the  
operation of your Mercedes-Benz.  
Please abide by the warnings and cautions contained in this manual. They are designed to help improve the safety  
of the vehicle operator and occupants.  
We extend our best wishes for many miles of safe, pleasurable driving.  
DaimlerChrysler AG  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Panic button ................................. 33 BabySmartTM airbag  
Introduction  
deactivation system ....................64  
Mechanical keys .......................... 33  
Doors ................................................. 34  
Central locking switch .................... 36  
Automatic central locking .......... 37  
Self-test BabySmartTM without  
special child seat installed .........64  
Supplemental restraint  
Product information .......................... 7  
Operator’s manual ............................. 8  
Where to find it ................................ 13  
Reporting Safety Defects ................ 15  
system (SRS) ................................65  
Emergency tensioning  
retractor (ETR) .............................65  
Airbags ..............................................66  
Safety guidelines for the  
seat belt, emergency  
tensioning retractor  
and airbag .....................................72  
Infant and child  
restraint systems .......................... 74  
Emergency unlocking  
in case of accident ...................... 37  
Instruments and controls  
Trunk ................................................. 38  
Trunk lid release switch ................ 40  
Trunk lid emergency release .........41  
Tow-away alarm ............................... 44  
Power seats, front ............................ 45  
Front head restraints ...................51  
Roll bar and  
Instruments and controls ............... 18  
Center console ..............................20  
Overhead control panel ...............21  
Operation  
Vehicle keys ......................................24  
Start lock-out ....................................27  
General notes on the  
central locking system ...............27  
Central locking system ...................28  
Radio frequency and infrared  
remote control ..............................28  
Opening and closing  
Adjusting telescoping  
head restraints, rear .................. 52  
Backrest ............................................ 54  
Multicontour seat ............................ 55  
Heated seats ..................................... 56  
Seat belts and integrated  
restraint system .......................... 58  
Seat belts .......................................... 58  
Seat belt nonusage  
steering column .......................... 76  
Inside rear view mirror ..................77  
Antiglare night position ..............77  
Exterior rear view mirrors .............78  
Instrument cluster ...........................82  
Indicator lamps in the  
instrument cluster ......................84  
Multifunction steering wheel,  
windows from outside .................32  
warning system ............................ 59  
multifunction display .................88  
Contents  
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
2
Trip and main odometer,  
Engine oil consumption ................113 Interior lighting .............................149  
Exterior lamp switch ......................114 Sun visors .......................................150  
Night security illumination .......... 115 Illuminated vanity mirrors ...........150  
Headlamp cleaning system ........... 116 Interior ............................................ 151  
Combination switch .......................117 Storage compartments,  
vehicle speed, FSS and  
engine oil level indicator ...........92  
Audio systems ..................................93  
Radio ..............................................93  
CD player .......................................94  
Cassette player .............................95  
Telephone ..........................................96  
Telephone book ............................96  
Redialing .......................................98  
Incoming call ..............................100  
Navigation system .......................... 101  
Trip computer .................................102  
Malfunction message  
armrest and cup holder ........... 151  
Hazard warning flasher  
switch ..........................................119  
Glove box ..................................... 151  
Automatic climate control ............ 120 Ashtray ............................................154  
Display and controls ................. 122 Lighter .............................................155  
Basic setting ............................... 122 Cargo tie down rings .....................156  
Economy ...................................... 123 Parcel net in front  
passenger footwell ....................156  
Armrest, rear bench ......................156  
Telephone, general ........................157  
Cellular telephone .........................157  
Special settings .......................... 123  
Rear window defroster .............. 124  
Air recirculation ........................ 125  
Residual engine  
memory ......................................104  
Individual settings .........................106  
Setting the audio volume ..............108  
Flexible service system  
heat utilization ........................... 125 Garage door opener .......................158  
Dust filter .................................... 126 Soft top ............................................162  
Audio and telephone,  
Wind screen ....................................170  
(FSS) ............................................109  
operation .................................... 127  
Engine oil level indicator .............. 112  
Power windows .............................. 146  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Brakes ..........................................206  
Driving off ...................................207  
Parking ........................................ 207  
Tires ............................................. 208  
Snow chains ................................210  
Winter driving instructions ......211  
Deep water ...................................212  
Passenger compartment ............213  
Traveling abroad .........................213  
Cruise control .................................214  
(BAS) ...........................................216  
Antilock brake system  
(ABS) ...........................................218  
Electronic stability program  
(ESP) ........................................... 220  
What you should know  
at the gas station ......................224  
Check regularly and  
Driving  
Instrument cluster display  
Control and operation of  
radio transmitters .....................178  
The first 1 000 miles  
Malfunction and  
indicator lamps in the  
instrument cluster ....................228  
(1 500 km) .................................179  
On-board diagnostic system  
Check engine malfunction  
indicator lamp .............................228  
Brake warning lamp ..................229  
Supplemental restraint  
system (SRS)  
indicator lamp .............................230  
Fuel reserve and fuel cap  
placement warning ....................230  
Electronic stability program  
(ESP) — warning lamp ...............231  
BAS/ESP malfunction  
indicator lamp .............................231  
ABS malfunction  
indicator lamp .............................231  
Telescoping steering column –  
indicator lamp .............................232  
Seat belt warning lamp .............232  
Maintenance ...................................179  
Catalytic converter ........................180  
Emission control ............................ 181  
Tele Aid ...........................................182  
Steering lock ...................................192  
Starting and turning off  
the engine ..................................194  
Automatic transmission ...............195  
Parking brake .................................204  
Driving instructions ......................205  
Drive sensibly – save fuel .........205  
Drinking and driving .................205  
Pedals ...........................................205  
Power assistance ........................206  
before a long trip ......................226  
Contents  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
4
Malfunction and indicator  
lamps in the  
center console ...........................233  
AIRBAG OFF  
indicator lamp .............................233  
Roll bar warning lamp ...............233  
Malfunction and  
warning messages in the  
multifunction display ...............234  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE  
(engine control unit) ..................235  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE  
(several systems) ........................235  
BATTERY/ALTERNATOR ...........236  
ABS-SYSTEM ...............................237  
BRAKE ASSIST ...........................237  
BRAKE LINING WEAR ..............238  
BRAKE FLUID .............................238  
PARKING BRAKE .......................239  
ENGINE FAN ............................... 239  
COOLANT  
(coolant level) .............................240  
COOLANT TEMP.  
(coolant temperature) ............... 241  
LIGHTING SYSTEM ................... 242  
LIGHT SENSOR .......................... 243  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL ................... 244  
ELEC. STABIL. PROG.  
(Electronic stability  
program) .....................................245  
REMOVE KEY .............................245  
WASHER FLUID .........................246  
TELE AID .....................................247  
Practical hints  
First aid kit .....................................250  
Shelf below rear window ..............250  
Stowing things in  
the vehicle ..................................250  
Luggage cover .................................250  
Fuses ................................................252  
Hood .................................................254  
Checking engine oil level .............256  
Automatic transmission  
fluid level ...................................257  
Coolant level ...................................257  
Adding coolant ...........................258  
Windshield washer / headlamp  
cleaning system ........................259  
Windshield and headlamp  
washer fluid mixing ratio .........259  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Spare wheel, vehicle tools,  
Raising soft top manually ............ 291  
Antenna ..........................................298  
Manual release for  
Window cleaning .......................305  
Plastic and rubber parts ............305  
Wiper blade .................................305  
Light alloy wheels ......................305  
Instrument cluster .....................306  
storage compartment ................260  
Vehicle jack .....................................261  
Wheels .............................................262  
Tire replacement ........................262 Trunk lamp .....................................299  
Rotating wheels ..........................263 Replacing wiper  
fuel filler flap ............................ 298  
Steering wheel and  
gear selector lever ......................306  
blade insert ............................... 299  
Spare wheel ....................................264  
Changing wheels ...........................266  
Tire inflation pressure ..................271  
Battery .............................................272  
Towing the vehicle .........................276  
Exterior lamps ................................280  
Headlamp assembly ...................281  
Taillamp assemblies ..................283  
Adjusting headlamp aim ...............285  
Changing batteries in  
Cup holder ...................................306  
Seat belts .....................................306  
Headliner .....................................306  
Upholstery ...................................307  
Hard plastic trim items .............307  
Plastic and rubber parts ............307  
Wind screen ...............................307  
Rubber weatherstrip .................307  
Soft top .........................................308  
Vehicle care  
Cleaning and care  
Power washer .............................303  
Paintwork, painted body  
components ................................303  
Engine cleaning .........................304  
Tar stains ....................................304  
Vehicle washing .........................304  
Ornamental moldings ...............304  
Headlamps, taillamps,  
the electronic main key ...........288  
Synchronizing  
remote control ...........................290  
turn signal lenses ......................305  
Contents  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
6
Engine oil additives .......................319  
Air conditioner  
refrigerant ..................................319  
Brake fluid .......................................319  
Premium unleaded  
gasoline ...................................... 320  
Fuel requirements ........................ 320  
Gasoline additives ......................... 321  
Coolants .......................................... 321  
Consumer information ................. 323  
Technical data  
Index  
Spare parts service ........................ 310  
Warranty coverage ......................... 310  
Identification labels ....................... 311  
Layout of poly-V-belt drive ............ 312  
Technical data ................................ 313  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc. –  
Index ................................................325  
capacities ................................... 317  
Engine oils ...................................... 319  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Product information  
Kindly observe the following in your own best interest:  
We recommend using Mercedes-Benz original parts as well as conversion parts and accessories  
explicitly approved by us for your vehicle model.  
We have tested these parts to determine their reliability, safety and their special  
suitability for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.  
We are unable to make an assessment for other products and therefore cannot be held responsible  
for them, even if in individual cases an official approval or authorization by governmental or other  
agencies should exist. Use of such parts and accessories could adversely affect the safety, performance  
or reliability of your vehicle. Please do not use them.  
Mercedes-Benz original parts as well as conversion parts and accessories approved by us are available  
at your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center where you will receive comprehensive information, also on  
permissible technical modifications, and where proper installation will be performed.  
Introduction  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
8
Operator’s manual  
This Operator’s Manual contains a great deal of useful information. We urge you to read it carefully and familiarize  
yourself with the vehicle before driving.  
For your own safety and longer service life of the vehicle, we urge you to follow the instructions and warnings  
contained in this manual. Ignoring them could result in damage to the vehicle or personal injury to you or others.  
Vehicle damage caused by failure to follow instructions is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Your vehicle may have some or all of the equipment described in this manual. Therefore, you may find explanations  
for optional equipment not installed in your vehicle. If you have any questions about the operation of any equipment,  
your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center will be glad to demonstrate the proper procedures.  
Service and warranty information  
The Service and Warranty Information Booklet contains detailed information about the warranties covering your  
Mercedes-Benz, including:  
New Car Limited Warranty,  
Emission System Warranty,  
Emission Performance Warranty,  
California, Massachusetts, and Vermont Emission Control System Warranty  
(California, Massachusetts, and Vermont only),  
State Warranty Enforcement Laws (Lemon Laws).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Important notice for California retail buyers of Mercedes-Benz automobiles  
Under California law you may be entitled to a replacement of your vehicle or a refund of the purchase price, if  
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC or its authorized Mercedes-Benz Center fails to conform the vehicle to its express warranties  
after a reasonable number of repair attempts during the period of one year or 12 000 miles from original delivery of  
the vehicle. A reasonable number of repair attempts is presumed for a retail buyer (1) if the vehicle is out of service by  
reason of repair of substantial nonconformities for a cumulative total of more than 30 calendar days or (2) the same  
substantial non-conformity has been subject to repair four or more times and you have at least once directly  
notified us in writing of the need to repair the non-conformity and have given us an opportunity to perform the  
repair ourselves. Notifications should be sent to the nearest Mercedes-Benz Regional Office listed in the  
Service and Warranty Information Booklet.  
Maintenance  
The Service Booklet describes all the necessary maintenance work which should be performed at regular intervals.  
Always have the Service Booklet with you when you take the vehicle to your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for  
service. The service advisor will record each service in the booklet for you.  
Introduction  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
10  
Roadside assistance  
The Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Program provides factory trained technical help in the event of a breakdown.  
Calls to the toll-free Roadside Assistance number:  
1-800-FOR-MERCedes (in the USA)  
1-800-387-0100 (in Canada)  
will be answered by Mercedes-Benz Client Assistance Representatives 24 hours a day, 365 days a year.  
For additional information refer to the Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Program brochure in your glove box.  
Change of address or ownership  
If you change your address, be sure to send in the “Change of Address Notice” found in the Service and Warranty  
Information Booklet, or simply call the Mercedes-Benz Client Assistance Center (in the USA) at 1-800-FOR-MERCedes,  
or Customer Service (in Canada) at 1-800-387-0100. It is in your own interest that we can contact you should the need  
arise.  
If you sell your Mercedes, please leave all literature with the vehicle to make it available to the next operator.  
If you bought this vehicle used, be sure to send in the “Notice of Purchase of Used Car” found in the Service and  
Warranty Information Booklet, or call the Mercedes-Benz Client Assistance Center (in the USA) at  
1-800-FOR-MERCedes, or Customer Service (in Canada) at 1-800-387-0100.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operating your vehicle outside the USA or Canada  
If you plan to operate your vehicle in foreign countries, please be aware that:  
Service facilities or replacement parts may not be readily available,  
unleaded gasoline for vehicles with catalytic converters may not be available; the use of leaded fuels will damage  
the catalysts,  
gasoline may have a considerably lower octane rating, and improper fuel can cause engine damage.  
Certain Mercedes-Benz models are available for delivery in Europe under our European Delivery Program. For details,  
consult your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or write to:  
In the USA:  
In Canada:  
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC  
European Delivery Department  
One Mercedes Drive  
Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc.  
European Delivery Department  
849 Eglinton Avenue East  
Toronto, Ontario M4G 2L5  
Montvale, NJ 07645-0350  
Introduction  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
12  
We continuously strive to improve our product, and ask for your understanding that we reserve the right to make  
changes in design and equipment. Therefore, information, illustrations and descriptions in this Operator’s Manual  
might differ from your vehicle.  
Optional equipment is also described in this manual, including operating instructions wherever necessary. Since they  
are special-order items, the descriptions and illustrations herein may vary slightly from the actual equipment of your  
vehicle.  
If there are any equipment details that are not shown or described in this Operator’s Manual, your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center will be glad to inform you of correct care and operating procedures.  
The Operator’s Manual and Service Booklet are important documents and should be kept with the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Where to find it  
The Operator’s Manual is divided into eight sections:  
• Instruments and controls: An overview of all the controls that can be operated from the driver’s seat.  
• Operation: Information on the vehicle’s equipment and its operation.  
• Driving: Important information on driving.  
• Instrument cluster display: Displays and indicator lamps on the instrument cluster with brief instructions.  
• Practical hints: Assistance and instructions in the event of an emergency.  
• Car care: Instructions on caring for your vehicle.  
• Technical data: All the important technical data for your vehicle as well as consumer information such as fuels,  
coolants, lubricants etc. is contained here.  
• Index: Key terms to help you find a topic quickly.  
Other documents may also be supplied, depending on your vehicle’s equipment.  
Explanation of color used:  
Warning notices for the protection of yourself and  
others appear on red background.  
Introduction  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
14  
Problems with your vehicle  
If you should experience a problem with your vehicle, particularly one that you believe may affect  
its safe operation, we urge you to immediately contact your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center to  
have the problem diagnosed and corrected if required. If the matter is not handled to your  
satisfaction, please discuss the problem with the Mercedes-Benz Center management, or if  
necessary contact us at the following addresses:  
In the USA: Client Assistance Center  
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC  
One Mercedes Drive  
Montvale, NJ 07645-0350  
In Canada:  
Customer Relations Department  
Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc.  
849 Eglinton Avenue East  
Toronto, Ontario, M4G 2L5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
For the USA only:  
The following text is published as required of manufacturers under Title 49, Code of U.S. Federal Regulations,  
Part 575 pursuant to the “National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act of 1966”.  
Reporting Safety Defects  
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or  
death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration  
(NHTSA) in addition to notifying Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC.  
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety  
defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA  
cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your retailer, or Mercedes-Benz USA,  
LLC.  
To contact NHTSA, you may either call the Auto Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-800-424-9393  
(or 366-0123 in Washington, D.C. area) or write to: NHTSA, U.S. Department of Transportation,  
Washington, D.C. 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from  
the Hotline.  
Introduction  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and controls  
Instruments and controls ............... 18  
Center console ..............................20  
Overhead control panel ...............21  
Contents – Instruments and controls  
17  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Instruments and controls  
Instruments and controls  
18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
For more detailed descriptions see Index on page 325.  
13 Center air outlets, adjustable  
For adjustment of air outlets, refer to automatic climate  
control, see page 120.  
14 Air volume control for center air outlets  
15 Left front seat heater switch, see page 56  
16 Headlamp washer switch, see page 116  
1 Side air outlet, adjustable  
2 Air volume control for side air outlet  
3 Exterior lamp switch, see page 114  
4 Parking brake release, see page 204  
5 Parking brake pedal, see page 204  
6 Hood lock release, see page 254  
7 Combination switch, see page 117  
8 Cruise control switch, see page 214  
17 Roll bar switch, see page 53  
Roll bar warning lamp, see page 233  
18 Hazard warning flasher switch, see page 119  
19 Central locking switch, see page 36  
20 Switch for tow-away alarm, see page 44  
Indicator lamp for antitheft alarm system, see  
page 42  
21 Right front seat heater switch, see page 56  
9 Multifunction steering wheel, see page 88  
Horn (with electronic key in steering lock  
position 1 or 2)  
22 Automatic climate control, see page 120  
Rear window defroster switch, see page 124  
23 Glove box (illuminated with electronic key in  
10 Instrument cluster, see page 82  
steering lock position 1 or 2), see page 151  
11 Voice recognition system switch, see separate  
24 Audio system, see page 127  
25 Storage compartment  
operating instructions  
12 Steering lock with ignition/starter  
26 Ashtray with lighter, see page 154  
switch, see page 192  
Instruments and controls  
19  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Instruments and controls  
Center console  
20  
1 Soft top switch, see page 162  
2 ESP control switch, see page 222  
3 Program mode selector switch, see page 202  
4 Left power window switch (front), see page 146  
5 Right power window switch (front), see page 146  
6 Left power window switch (rear), see page 146  
7 Trunk lid release switch, see page 40  
1
3
ESP  
2
8 Mirror adjustment switch, see page 78  
9 Right power window switch (rear), see page 146  
10 Airbag Off indicator lamp, see page 233  
5
4
10  
9
7
8
6
P68.10-2191-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Overhead control panel  
1 Tele Aid (emergency call system), see page 182  
2 Interior lighting, see page 149  
1
3 Hands-free microphone for Tele Aid, telephone and  
voice recognition system.  
4 Rear view mirror, see page 77  
2
5 Garage door opener, see page 158  
3
4
5
Instruments and controls  
21  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Contents – Operation  
22  
Power seats, front ............................ 45  
Front head restraints ...................51  
Roll bar and  
head restraints, rear .................. 52  
Backrest ............................................ 54  
Multicontour seat ............................ 55  
Heated seats ..................................... 56  
Seat belts and integrated  
Seat belts .......................................... 58  
Infant and child  
restraint systems .......................... 74  
Adjusting telescoping  
steering column .......................... 76  
Inside rear view mirror ..................77  
Antiglare night position ..............77  
Exterior rear view mirrors .............78  
Instrument cluster ...........................82  
Operation  
Vehicle keys ......................................24  
Start lock-out ....................................27  
General notes on the  
central locking system ...............27  
Central locking system ...................28  
Radio frequency and infrared  
remote control ..............................28  
Opening and closing  
instrument cluster ......................84  
windows from outside .................32  
Panic button ..................................33  
Mechanical keys ...........................33  
Doors ..................................................34  
Central locking switch ....................36  
Automatic central locking ..........37  
Emergency unlocking  
in case of accident ......................37  
Trunk .................................................38  
Trunk lid release switch .................40  
Trunk lid emergency release ......... 41  
Antitheft alarm system ...................42  
Tow-away alarm ................................44  
Multifunction steering wheel,  
multifunction display .................88  
Trip and main odometer,  
Seat belt nonusage  
warning system ............................ 59  
BabySmartTM airbag  
vehicle speed, FSS and  
deactivation system ................... 64  
Self-test BabySmartTM without  
special child seat installed ......... 64  
Supplemental restraint  
system (SRS) ............................... 65  
Emergency tensioning  
retractor (ETR) ............................ 65  
Airbags .............................................. 66  
Safety guidelines for the  
seat belt, emergency  
tensioning retractor  
engine oil level indicator ...........92  
Audio systems ..................................93  
Radio ..............................................93  
CD player .......................................94  
Cassette player .............................95  
Telephone ..........................................96  
Telephone book ............................96  
Redialing .......................................98  
Incoming call ..............................100  
Navigation system .......................... 101  
and airbag ..................................... 72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Trip computer .................................102 Automatic climate control ............ 120 Illuminated vanity mirrors ...........150  
Malfunction message  
Display and controls ................. 122 Interior ............................................ 151  
Basic setting ............................... 122 Storage compartments,  
memory ......................................104  
Individual settings .........................106  
Setting the audio volume ..............108  
Flexible service system  
(FSS) ............................................109  
Engine oil level indicator .............. 112  
Engine oil consumption .................113  
Exterior lamp switch ......................114  
armrest and cup holder ........... 151  
Glove box ..................................... 151  
Ashtray ............................................154  
Lighter .............................................155  
Cargo tie down rings .....................156  
Economy ...................................... 123  
Special settings .......................... 123  
Rear window defroster .............. 124  
Air recirculation ........................ 125  
Residual engine  
heat utilization ........................... 125 Parcel net in front  
passenger footwell ....................156  
Dust filter .................................... 126  
Night security illumination ..........115  
Headlamp cleaning system ...........116  
Armrest, rear bench ......................156  
operation .................................... 127 Telephone, general ........................157  
Combination switch .......................117 Power windows .............................. 146 Cellular telephone .........................157  
Hazard warning flasher  
Interior lighting ............................. 149 Garage door opener .......................158  
Sun visors ........................................150 Soft top ............................................162  
Wind screen ....................................170  
switch ...........................................119  
Contents – Operation  
23  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Warning!  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
Vehicle keys  
24  
Included with your vehicle are:  
When leaving the vehicle always remove the  
electronic key from the steering lock, and lock your  
vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the  
vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.  
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment may cause  
serious personal injury.  
2 electronic main keys with integrated radio  
frequency and infrared remote controls plus  
removable mechanical key.  
The locking tabs for the mechanical key portion of  
the two electronic main keys are a different color to  
help distinguish it.  
1 electronic reserve key without remote control  
functions, plus removable mechanical key.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Electronic main key  
When using the mechanical key (2) for lock operations,  
it can be removed by sliding it out of the remote control.  
To do so, move locking tab (3) to the right and slide the  
mechanical key (2) in direction of arrow (4).  
The remote control transmitter is located in the  
electronic main key.  
1
The infrared receivers are located in the door handles.  
Notes:  
3
Remove the mechanical key from the electronic main  
key when using valet parking service. To prevent access  
to trunk or storage compartments lock them separately  
and retain the mechanical key.  
2
4
P80.35-2031-26  
See page 38 for separate locking of trunk and page 151  
for locking of glove box.  
The electronic main key has an integrated radio  
frequency and infrared remote control, plus removable  
mechanical key.  
The remote control (1) operates all locks on the vehicle.  
The mechanical key (2) works only in the driver’s door,  
trunk, and storage compartment locks.  
Central locking system  
25  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
Electronic reserve key  
26  
The electronic reserve key (1) works only in the steering  
lock. There are no batteries inside the electronic reserve  
key.  
The mechanical key (2) works only in the driver’s door,  
trunk, and storage compartment locks.  
1
To use the mechanical key (2), remove it from its  
electronic reserve key (1).  
Note:  
We recommend that you carry the electronic reserve  
key plus mechanical key with you and keep it in a safe  
place (e.g. your wallet) so that it is always handy. Never  
leave the electronic reserve key in the vehicle.  
P80.35-2036-26  
Obtaining replacement keys  
The electronic reserve key is without remote control  
functions, but with removable mechanical key.  
Your vehicle is equipped with a theft deterrent locking  
system requiring a special key manufacturing process.  
For security reasons, replacement keys can only be  
obtained from your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Start lock-out  
Important!  
General notes on the central locking system  
If the electronic key is inserted in the steering lock, the  
vehicle cannot be locked or unlocked with the remote  
control.  
Removing the electronic key from the steering lock  
activates the start lock-out. The engine cannot be  
started.  
If the vehicle cannot be locked or unlocked:  
Aim transmitter eye at a receiver of either door  
handle. Check the batteries of the electronic main  
key, see page 288, or synchronize the remote  
control, see page 290.  
Inserting the electronic key in the steering lock  
deactivates the start lock-out.  
Note:  
Use the mechanical key to unlock the driver’s door.  
To start the engine, insert the electronic main key in  
the steering lock. There could be a slight delay until  
the electronic main key can be turned in the  
steering lock.  
In case the engine cannot be started (vehicle’s battery is  
in order), the system is not operational. Contact an  
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or call 1-800-FOR-  
MERCedes (in the USA) or 1-800-387-0100 (in Canada).  
Important!  
When unlocking the driver’s door with the mechanical  
key, the exterior lamps will flash and the alarm will  
sound.  
To cancel the alarm, insert the electronic key in the  
steering lock or press button Œ or on the  
electronic main key.  
Central locking system  
27  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
Central locking system  
28  
4
Radio frequency and infrared remote control  
3
The electronic main key has an integrated radio  
frequency and infrared remote control.  
2
1
Due to the extended operational range of the remote  
control, it could be possible to unintentionally lock or  
unlock the vehicle by pressing the transmit button. If  
one of the transmit buttons is pressed, the battery check  
lamp lights up briefly – indicating that the batteries are  
in order. See page 288 for checking batteries.  
5
P80.35-2032-26  
The vehicle doors, trunk and fuel filler flap can be  
centrally locked and unlocked via remote control.  
1 Transmit button  
Locking  
Opening and closing the windows remotely can only be  
done with the infrared portion of the remote control.  
Aim transmitter eye at a receiver (6 or 7), press and  
hold transmit button Œ or .  
Œ Unlocking  
Š Opening trunk (if not separately locked)  
If the electronic key is inserted in steering lock, the  
vehicle cannot be locked or unlocked with the remote  
control.  
2 Lamp for battery check (see page 288 for changing  
batteries if it does not light up briefly)  
3 PANIC button  
4 Transmitter eye  
5 Locking tab for mechanical key  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
6
7
P80.30-2081-26  
P80.30-2082-20  
6 Infrared receiver in driver’s door handle  
7 Infrared receiver in passenger door handle  
Central locking system  
Instruments  
29  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
and controls  
cluster display  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
30  
Locking and unlocking with remote control  
The presently active unlocking mode (selective or  
global) can only be determined by unlocking the vehicle  
with the remote control (see below for changing mode).  
Unlocking:  
If within 40 seconds of unlocking with the remote  
control, neither door nor trunk is opened, the electronic  
key is not inserted in the steering lock, or the central  
locking switch is not activated, the vehicle will  
automatically lock.  
Press transmit button Œ. All turn signal lamps blink  
once to indicate that the vehicle is unlocked.  
The remote control can be programmed for two kinds of  
unlocking modes (see below):  
Selective unlocking mode –  
Press transmit button Œ once to unlock driver’s door  
and fuel filler flap.  
Press transmit button Œ twice to unlock both doors,  
fuel filler flap, and trunk.  
Locking:  
Press transmit button once. All turn signal lamps  
blink three times to indicate that the vehicle is locked.  
If they do not blink three times, a door or trunk is not  
properly closed.  
Global unlocking mode –  
Press transmit button Œ once to unlock both doors,  
fuel filler flap, and trunk.  
Note:  
Notes:  
If the vehicle cannot be locked or unlocked by pressing  
the transmit button, then it may be necessary to change  
the batteries in the electronic main key (if ok, battery  
check lamp in electronic main key will light briefly  
when pressing transmit button) or to synchronize the  
remote control, see pages 288 and 290.  
If the trunk was previously locked separately, it will  
remain locked, see page 38.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Choosing global or selective mode on remote control  
Important!  
Press and hold transmit buttons and Œ  
simultaneously for approx. 6 seconds to reprogram the  
remote control. Battery check lamp will blink two times  
indicating the completed mode change.  
Do not place remote control in trunk since trunk is  
locked when the lid is closed if the vehicle is centrally  
locked.  
Note:  
If the trunk was previously locked separately, it will  
remain locked, see page 38.  
Opening the trunk  
Press transmit button Š until trunk lid is released.  
A minimum height clearance of 5.9 ft. (1.8 m) is  
required to open the trunk lid.  
Central locking system  
31  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
32  
Opening and closing windows from outside  
Note:  
If the windows cannot be operated automatically by  
pressing the transmit button of the remote control then  
it may be necessary to change the batteries in the  
electronic main key (if ok, battery check lamp in  
electronic main key will light briefly when pressing  
transmit button), or to synchronize the remote control,  
see page 288 and 290.  
Aim transmitter eye of remote control at a door receiver.  
To open:  
Continue to press transmit button Œ after unlocking  
the vehicle.  
The windows begin to open after approx. 1 second.  
To interrupt opening procedure, release transmit  
button.  
Warning!  
Never operate the windows if there is the  
possibility of anyone being harmed by the opening  
or closing procedure.  
To close:  
Continue to press transmit button after locking  
In case the procedure causes potential danger, the  
procedure can be immediately halted by releasing  
the remote control button. To reverse direction of  
movement press Œ for opening or for  
closing.  
the vehicle.  
The windows begin to close after approx. 1 second.  
To interrupt closing procedure, release transmit button.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Panic button  
Note:  
For operation in the USA only: This device complies  
with Part 15, Subpart C, Section 209 of the FCC Rules.  
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
(1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and  
1
(2) this device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired  
operation.  
WARNING: Changes or modification not expressly  
approved by party responsible for compliance could void  
the user’s authority to operate the equipment.  
P80.35-2035-26  
Mechanical keys  
To activate press and hold button (1) for at least one  
second. An audible alarm and blinking exterior lamps  
will operate for approximately 3 minutes.  
The mechanical keys work only in the driver’s door,  
trunk, and storage compartment locks.  
Notes:  
To deactivate press button (1) again, or insert electronic  
key in steering lock.  
The mechanical key does not operate the central locking  
system or antitheft alarm system.  
The fuel filler flap cannot be locked or unlocked with  
the mechanical key.  
Central locking system  
33  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
Doors  
34  
3
2
1
1
1 Opening – pull handle  
Important!  
2 Unlocking driver’s door  
The mechanical key does not operate the central locking  
system or antitheft alarm system.  
3 Locking driver’s door  
4 Individual door from inside:  
Push lock button down to lock.  
Pull inside door handle to unlock.  
When you lock the driver’s door with the mechanical  
key, the door lock button should move down.  
The passenger door must be locked with the door lock  
button – the driver’s door can only be locked when it is  
closed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
If the vehicle has previously been locked from the  
outside, opening a door from the inside will trigger the  
alarm. When opening a door while the central locking  
system is in the:  
To lock, push down lock button and turn mechanical key  
in driver’s door lock to position 3. In addition lock the  
trunk.  
To unlock, pull inside door handle and turn mechanical  
key in driver’s door lock to position 2.  
selective unlocking mode, only that individual door  
is unlocked. The remaining door, the trunk and fuel  
filler flap remain locked,  
When unlocking the driver’s door with the mechanical  
key, the exterior lamps will flash and the alarm will  
sound.  
global unlocking mode, both doors, the trunk and  
fuel filler flap are unlocked.  
To cancel the alarm, insert the electronic key in the  
steering lock or press button Œ or on the  
electronic main key.  
Notes:  
When opening a door, the door window lowers slightly.  
After closing the door, the window closes again.  
In case of a malfunction in the central locking system  
the doors can be locked and unlocked individually.  
Central locking system  
35  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
Central locking switch  
36  
If the vehicle was previously locked with the central  
locking switch, while in the global remote control mode,  
the complete vehicle is unlocked when a door is opened  
from the inside.  
Notes:  
If the vehicle was previously locked with the remote  
control, the doors and trunk cannot be unlocked with  
the central locking switch.  
If the vehicle has previously been locked from the  
outside, opening a door with the inside door handle will  
trigger the alarm. To cancel the alarm, insert the  
electronic key in the steering lock or press button Œ  
or on the electronic main key.  
The fuel filler flap cannot be locked or unlocked with  
the central locking switch.  
1 Locking  
2 Unlocking  
Warning!  
The central locking switch is located in the center  
console.  
When leaving the vehicle always remove the  
electronic key from the steering lock, and lock your  
vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the  
vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.  
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment may cause  
serious personal injury.  
The doors and trunk can only be locked with the central  
locking switch, if both doors are closed.  
If the vehicle was previously locked with the central  
locking switch, while in the selective remote control  
mode, only the door opened from the inside is unlocked.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Automatic central locking  
If a door is opened from the inside at speeds of approx.  
9 mph (15 km/h) or less with the automatic central  
locking activated, the door will again be automatically  
locked at speeds of approx. 9 mph (15 km/h) or more.  
The central locking switch also operates the automatic  
central locking.  
With the automatic central locking system activated, the  
doors and trunk are locked at vehicle speeds of approx.  
9 mph (15 km/h) or more. The fuel filler flap remains  
unlocked.  
Important!  
When towing the vehicle, or with the vehicle on a  
dynamometer test stand, please, note the following:  
To activate:  
With the automatic central locking activated and the  
electronic key in steering lock position 2, the vehicle  
doors will lock if the left front wheel as well as the right  
rear wheel spin at vehicle speeds of approx. 9 mph  
(15 km/h) or more.  
With electronic key in steering lock position 2 hold  
upper portion of switch (1) for a minimum of 5 seconds.  
To deactivate:  
To prevent the vehicle door locks from locking,  
deactivate the automatic central locking.  
With electronic key in steering lock position 2 hold  
lower portion of switch (2) for a minimum of 5 seconds.  
Emergency unlocking in case of accident  
Notes:  
If doors are unlocked with the central locking switch  
after activating the automatic central locking, and  
neither door is opened, then the doors remain unlocked  
even at vehicle speeds of approx. 9 mph (15 km/h) or  
more.  
The doors unlock automatically a short time after a  
strong deceleration is detected, such as in a collision  
(this is intended to aid rescue and exit).  
Driving on rough roads may cause the vehicle to unlock.  
If necessary, the vehicle can be locked again with the  
central locking switch, see page 36.  
Central locking system  
37  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
Trunk  
38  
When the trunk is separately locked, it remains locked  
when centrally unlocking the vehicle.  
To deny any unauthorized person access to the trunk,  
lock it separately with the mechanical key. Leave only  
the electronic main key less its mechanical key with the  
vehicle.  
Notes:  
The mechanical key does not operate the central locking  
system or antitheft alarm system.  
When unlocking the trunk with the mechanical key, the  
exterior lamps will flash and the alarm will sound.  
0 Neutral position – push to open (arrow)  
To cancel the alarm, insert the electronic key in the  
steering lock or press button Œ or on the  
electronic main key.  
1 Unlocking  
2 Separate locking of trunk – remove mechanical key  
in this position.  
The trunk lid cannot be opened by the trunk lid release  
switch or the electronic main key when previously  
locked separately with the mechanical key.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Notes:  
In case of a malfunction in the central locking system  
the trunk can be unlocked individually.  
To unlock and open the trunk lid, turn mechanical key  
to position 1, hold and push to open.  
If the fuel filler flap cannot be opened, see page 298.  
1
Important!  
Do not place mechanical key inside trunk, since trunk is  
locked when the lid is closed if the vehicle has been  
previously centrally locked.  
P88.50-2009-26  
To prevent damage to the trunk lid and the soft top  
compartment cover, do not open the trunk lid while the  
soft top is being raised or lowered.  
Lower trunk lid using handle (1) and close it with hands  
placed flat on trunk lid. Please remember to keep your  
fingers out of the space between the lid and the vehicle.  
Central locking system  
39  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Central locking system  
Trunk lid release switch  
40  
A minimum height clearance of 5.9 ft. (1.8 m) is  
required to open the trunk lid.  
To open the trunk, the vehicle must be at standstill. Pull  
up on switch until trunk lid is open.  
The indicator lamp in the switch remains on with trunk  
lid open.  
Notes:  
The trunk can also be opened by using the electronic  
main key. Press Š button.  
The trunk lid cannot be opened by the switch or the  
remote control when previously locked separately with  
the mechanical key. To open, see page 38.  
The trunk lid cannot be opened with the trunk lid  
release switch when the vehicle was previously locked  
with the central locking switch. To unlock vehicle with  
the central locking switch, see page 36.  
The switch is located on the center console.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Trunk lid emergency release  
Note:  
The emergency release button (1) only unlocks and  
opens the trunk while the vehicle is standing.  
Important!  
The emergency trunk lid release button (1) does not  
open the trunk lid, if:  
the vehicle battery is discharged or disconnected,  
the trunk lid was previously locked separately with  
1
the mechanical key, see page 38.  
Illumination of the emergency release button (1):  
The button will blink for 30 minutes after opening the  
trunk.  
The emergency release button (1) is located in the trunk  
lid.  
The button will blink for 60 minutes after closing the  
trunk.  
Briefly press emergency release button (1).  
All doors, the fuel filler flap, and the trunk unlock; and  
the trunk lid opens.  
Central locking system  
41  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Antitheft alarm system  
Antitheft alarm system  
42  
The antitheft alarm is automatically armed or disarmed  
with the remote control by locking or unlocking the  
vehicle.  
The antitheft alarm is armed within approx. 10 seconds  
after locking the vehicle.  
A blinking lamp (1) indicates that the alarm is armed.  
1
Operation:  
Once the alarm system has been armed, the exterior  
vehicle lamps will flash and an alarm will sound when  
someone:  
opens a door,  
opens the trunk,  
1 Indicator lamp in switch located in center console  
opens the hood,  
attempts to raise the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
The alarm will last approximately 3 minutes in form of  
flashing exterior lamps. At the same time an alarm will  
sound for 30 seconds. The alarm will stay on even if the  
activating element (a door, for example) is immediately  
closed. The antitheft alarm system is switched off  
automatically if the vehicle is unlocked with the  
electronic main key. If the alarm stays on for more than  
20 seconds, an emergency call is initiated automatically.  
See Tele Aid on page 182.  
Notes:  
We recommend that you carry the electronic reserve  
key plus mechanical key with you and keep it in a safe  
place (e.g. your wallet) so that it is always handy. Never  
leave the electronic reserve key in the vehicle.  
When you unlock the driver’s door with the mechanical  
key, the exterior lamps will flash and the alarm will  
sound.  
To interrupt the alarm, insert the electronic key in the  
steering lock or press button Œ or on the  
electronic main key.  
Antitheft alarm system  
43  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tow-away alarm  
44  
Tow-away alarm  
The alarm will last approximately 3 minutes in form of  
flashing exterior lamps. At the same time an alarm will  
sound for 30 seconds. The alarm will stay on even if the  
vehicle is immediately lowered. The tow-away alarm  
system is switched off automatically if the vehicle is  
unlocked with the electronic main key.  
If the alarm stays on for more than 20 seconds, an  
emergency call is initiated automatically. See Tele Aid  
on page 182.  
To prevent triggering the tow-away alarm feature, switch  
off the tow-away alarm before towing the vehicle, or  
when parking on a surface subject to movement, such  
as a ferry or auto train.  
To do so, turn electronic key in steering lock to  
position 1 or 0, or remove electronic key from steering  
lock. Press tow-away alarm switch (1). The indicator  
lamp (2) illuminates briefly.  
The switch is located in the center console.  
1 Press to switch off  
Exit vehicle, and lock vehicle with the remote control.  
2 Indicator lamp  
The tow-away alarm remains switched off until the  
vehicle is locked again with the remote control, at which  
time it is automatically reactivated.  
Once the alarm system has been armed, the exterior  
vehicle lamps will flash and an alarm will sound when  
someone attempts to raise the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Power seats, front  
Warning!  
Warning!  
Do not adjust the driver’s seat while driving.  
Adjusting the seat while driving could cause the  
driver to lose control of the vehicle.  
When leaving the vehicle always remove the  
electronic key from the steering lock, and lock your  
vehicle.  
Never ride in a moving vehicle with the backrest  
reclined. Sitting in an excessively reclined position  
can be dangerous. You could slide under the seat  
belt in a collision. If you slide under it, the belt  
would apply force at the abdomen or neck. That  
could cause serious or even fatal injuries. The  
backrest and seat belt provide the best restraint  
when the wearer is in an upright position and the  
belt is properly positioned on the body.  
The power seats can also be operated with the  
driver’s or passenger door open. Do not leave  
children unattended in the vehicle or with access  
to an unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use of vehicle  
equipment may cause serious personal injury.  
To operate the front power seat adjustment switches,  
turn electronic key in steering lock to position 1 or 2  
(with the driver’s or passenger’s door open, the power  
seats can also be operated with the electronic key  
removed or in steering lock position 0).  
Never place hands under seat or near any moving  
parts while a seat is being adjusted.  
Seats  
45  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Seats  
46  
safely. The position should be as far rearward as  
possible, consistent with ability to properly operate  
controls.  
5
Note:  
4
Do not move the front passenger seat completely  
forward if objects are stored in the parcel net in the  
front passenger side footwell. Items in the net may  
be damaged.  
2
2
1
3
3 Seat cushion tilt  
Press the switch in the direction of the arrow until  
your legs are lightly supported.  
4 Backrest tilt  
Press the switch in the direction of the arrow until  
your arms are slightly angled when holding the  
steering wheel.  
The slide switches are located in each door.  
We recommend to adjust the power seat in the following  
order:  
5 Head restraint  
1 Seat, up/down  
During seat adjustment, the head restraint is  
automatically adjusted based on seat (fore/aft)  
position to support the back of the head  
approximately at ear level. Please check the position  
of the head restraint to assure that it supports the  
back of the head approximately at ear level. The  
head restraint angle can also be adjusted manually.  
Press the switch (up/down direction) until  
comfortable seating position with still sufficient  
headroom is reached.  
2 Seat, fore/aft  
Press the switch (fore/aft direction) until a  
comfortable seating position is reached that still  
allows you to reach the accelerator/brake pedal  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notes:  
Caution!  
Your vehicle is equipped with power head restraints, do  
not try to raise or lower them manually.  
Do not remove head restraints except when mounting  
seat covers. For removal see page 51. Whenever  
restraints have been removed be sure to reinstall them  
before driving.  
Only minor personal adjustments, as described below,  
should then be required.  
For steering wheel adjustment, see page 76;  
inside rear view mirror, see page 77;  
exterior rear view mirrors, see page 78.  
Seats  
47  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Storing  
Car care  
Index  
Seats  
48  
Memory storing and recalling  
Three sets of seat/head restraint and exterior rear view  
mirror positions may be programmed into memory.  
After the seat/head restraint and exterior rear view  
mirrors are positioned, push memory button (6),  
release, and within 3 seconds push position button “1”.  
A second and third set of positions for the same seat/  
head restraint and exterior rear view mirrors can be  
programmed into memory by pushing first memory  
button (6) and then “2”, respectively “3”.  
Note:  
See page 78 for instructions on adjustment of mirrors.  
6 Memory button  
7 Position buttons  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Recalling  
Synchronizing power seats and head restraints  
To recall a seat/head restraint and exterior rear view  
mirror position, push and hold position button “1”, “2”  
or “3” until seat/head restraint and exterior rear view  
mirror movement has stopped. The seat/head restraint  
and exterior rear view mirror movement stops when the  
position button is released.  
If the power supply was interrupted (battery  
disconnected or empty), the power seats and head  
restraints are no longer adjusted automatically.  
To resynchronize the adjustment feature, turn  
electronic key in steering lock to position 2, move the  
seat completely forward and the head restraint fully  
down, and hold respective buttons for approx.  
2 seconds.  
Caution!  
Do not operate the power seats using the memory  
button if the backrest is in an excessively reclined  
position. Doing so could cause damage to front or rear  
seats.  
First move the backrest to an upright position.  
Seats  
49  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Warning!  
Car care  
Index  
Seats  
50  
Important!  
Prior to operating the vehicle, the driver should adjust  
the seat height for proper vision as well as fore/aft  
placement and backrest angle to insure adequate  
control, reach, operation, and comfort. The head  
restraint should also be adjusted for proper height. See  
also airbag section on page 66 for proper seat  
positioning.  
Children 12 years old and under must never ride in  
the front seat, except in a Mercedes-Benz  
authorized BabySmartTM compatible child seat,  
which operates with the BabySmartTM system  
installed in the vehicle to deactivate the passenger  
side front airbag when it is properly installed.  
Otherwise they will be struck by the airbag when it  
inflates in a crash. If this happens, serious or fatal  
injury can result.  
In addition, also adjust the steering wheel to ensure  
adequate control, reach, operation, and comfort.  
According to accident statistics, children are safer  
when properly restrained in the rear seating  
positions than in the front seating positions.  
Infants and small children must ride in back seats  
and be seated in an appropriate infant or child  
restraint system, which is properly secured with  
the vehicle’s seat belt, fully in accordance with the  
child seat manufacturer’s instructions.  
Both the inside and outside rear view mirrors should be  
adjusted for adequate rearward vision.  
Fasten seat belts. Infants and small children should be  
seated in a properly secured restraint system that  
complies with U.S. Federal Motor Vehicle Safety  
Standard 213 and Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety  
Standard 213.  
A child’s risk of serious or fatal injuries is  
significantly increased if the child restraints are  
not properly secured in the vehicle and the child is  
not properly secured in the child restraint.  
All seat, head restraint, steering wheel, and rear view  
mirror adjustments as well as fastening of seat belts  
should be done before the vehicle is put into motion.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Front head restraints  
Warning!  
For your protection, drive only with properly  
positioned head restraints.  
Adjust head restraint to support the back of the  
head approximately at ear level.  
Do not drive the vehicle without the seat head  
restraints. Head restraints are intended to help  
reduce injuries during an accident.  
Removal:  
Installation:  
Tilt the backrest rearward for easier removal of the front  
head restraints.  
Push button (1) of the power adjustable head restraint  
up for approximately 5 seconds.  
Push button (1) up to bring the power adjustable head  
restraint to its highest position.  
Insert the head restraint and push it down to the stop.  
Adjust head restraint to the desired position.  
Pull out head restraint completely with both hands.  
For positioning of head restraints see also power seats,  
front on page 45, and head restraints, rear on page 53.  
Seats  
51  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Warning!  
Car care  
Index  
Seats  
52  
Roll bar and head restraints, rear  
The rear head restraints are integrated in the roll bar.  
Raising or lowering of the roll bar could injure rear  
seated occupants.  
The roll bar will be automatically raised in an accident  
or in a potentially dangerous driving situation. A ratchet  
noise can be heard when the roll bar is automatically  
raised.  
Before operating the roll bar switch make sure that  
the roll bar’s path is clear and no persons due to  
inattention are injured by the moving roll bar.  
For your own safety we recommend to drive with  
the roll bar raised, if  
The roll bar can be lowered again after an automatic  
deployment by pressing the upper half of the roll bar  
switch (for at least 8 seconds) until the roll bar drive  
mechanism audibly engages. Then press the lower half  
of the switch to lower the roll bar.  
• the outside temperature is below +5°F (-15°C).  
• the rear seats are occupied by passengers.  
Before working on the vehicle, e.g. when changing  
wheels, the roll bar should be raised with the  
switch, and the electronic key should be removed  
from the steering lock, to prevent possible injury.  
If the roll bar was raised using the switch, it will be  
automatically lowered when activating the soft top  
switch.  
In case of potential danger release the switch to  
immediately interrupt the operating procedure.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Switch for roll bar and head restraints, rear  
With the engine running and the roll bar lowered, the  
warning lamp in the roll bar switch will blink for  
approx. 15 seconds. The blinking is reminding you to  
raise the roll bar if the rear passenger seats are  
occupied. See also page 233 for roll bar warning lamp.  
1
2
Important!  
The roll bar is intended to be a safety enhancement to  
the other features designed into the vehicle. No system  
in any vehicle can eliminate the possibility of serious  
injury or fatality in an accident. Properly fastened seat  
belts and child restraints must be used!  
Notes:  
P91.59-2001-26  
If the warning lamp in the switch comes on, then a  
malfunction has been detected. In this case, drive only  
with the roll bar raised until the problem has been  
corrected. Raise the roll bar by pressing the upper half  
of the roll bar switch.  
The switch is located in the center console.  
Turn electronic key in steering lock to position 2.  
Press switch:  
Have the system checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
1 Raise roll bar  
2 Lower roll bar  
Items being transported in the rear passenger  
compartment should be placed in such a manner as not  
to affect the movement of the roll bar when being  
raised.  
The lowering or raising procedure is immediately  
interrupted by releasing the roll bar switch.  
Seats  
53  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Seats  
54  
Backrest  
Notes:  
The automatic seat slide is provided with a safety  
feature. The automatic process is interrupted, if the  
backrest of the sliding seat is pushed against an  
occupant or object. The seat will slide forward, stop, and  
make 3 attempts sliding backward.  
To halt the automatic process, activate the power seat  
switch. Investigate and correct the cause of interruption.  
Now use memory button or power seat switch to bring  
seat into desired position.  
The backrest release lever (1) also serves as a rest for  
the front seat belt, bringing it within easy reach.  
Warning!  
1 Release lever  
When leaving the vehicle always remove the  
electronic key from the steering lock, and lock your  
vehicle.  
Folding forward:  
Lift release lever (1) and fold backrest forward. The seat  
will automatically slide forward and the head restraint  
will move down.  
The power seats can also be operated with the  
driver’s or passenger door open. Do not leave  
children unattended in the vehicle or with access  
to an unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use of vehicle  
equipment may cause serious personal injury.  
Folding back:  
Lift release lever (1) and fold backrest back. The seat  
and head restraint return to their previous positions.  
Never place hands under seat or near any moving  
parts during a seat adjustment procedure.  
To interrupt the procedure, activate the power seat  
switch.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Multicontour seat (optional)  
We recommend to adjust the multicontour seat in the  
following order:  
1 Seat cushion depth  
Slide the switch fore or aft until your legs are  
supported comfortably.  
4
2 Backrest bottom  
3 Backrest center  
3
2
4 Side bolster adjustment  
Adjust the side bolster to provide good lateral  
support.  
1
The seat cushion movement and amount of backrest  
cushion height and curvature can be continuously  
varied with regulators (1, 2 and 3) after turning the  
electronic key in steering lock to position 2.  
P91.25-2063-26  
Some models may be equipped with multicontour seats.  
These seats have movable seat cushions, and inflatable  
air cushions built into the backrest to provide additional  
lumbar and side support.  
The side bolsters of the backrest can be adjusted with  
rocker switch (4):  
press to the right – increase side support,  
press to the left – decrease side support.  
If the engine is turned off, the last cushion setting is  
retained in memory, and automatically adjusts the  
cushion to this setting when the engine is restarted.  
Seats  
55  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Seats  
56  
Heated seats, front (optional)  
Press switch to turn on seat heater:  
1 Normal seat heating mode. One indicator lamp in  
the switch lights up.  
2 Rapid seat heating mode. Both indicator lamps in  
1
the switch light up.  
After approximately 5 minutes in the rapid seat  
heating mode, the seat heater automatically  
switches to normal operation and only one indicator  
lamp will stay on.  
2
Turning off seat heater:  
If one indicator lamp is on, press upper half of switch.  
P54.25-2036-26  
If both indicator lamps are on, press lower half of  
switch.  
The front seat heater switches are located in the center  
console.  
If left on, the seat heater automatically turns off after  
approximately 30 minutes of operation.  
The front seat heaters can be switched on with the  
electronic key in steering lock positions 1 or 2.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notes:  
When in operation, the seat heater consumes a large  
amount of electrical power. It is not advisable to use the  
seat heater longer than necessary.  
The seat heaters may automatically switch off if too  
many power consumers are switched on at the same  
time, or if the battery charge is low. When this occurs,  
the indicator lamp in the switch will blink (both  
indicator lamps blink during rapid seat heating mode).  
The seat heaters will switch on again automatically as  
soon as sufficient voltage is available.  
If the blinking of the indicator lamps is distracting to  
you, the seat heaters can be switched off.  
Seats  
57  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Warning!  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
58  
Seat belts and integrated restraint system  
Your vehicle is equipped with seat belts for all seats,  
emergency tensioning retractors for the front seat belts,  
dual front airbags, door mounted side impact airbags  
and knee bolsters for driver and front passenger. Their  
protective functions are designed to complement one  
another.  
Children 12 years old and under must never ride in  
the front seat, except in a Mercedes-Benz  
authorized BabySmartTM compatible child seat,  
which operates with the BabySmartTM system  
installed in the vehicle to deactivate the passenger  
side front airbag when it is properly installed.  
Otherwise they will be struck by the airbag when it  
inflates in a crash. If this happens, serious or fatal  
injury will result.  
Seat belts  
According to accident statistics, children are safer  
when properly restrained in the rear seating  
positions than in the front seating positions.  
Infants and small children must ride in back seats  
and be seated in an appropriate infant or child  
restraint system, which is properly secured with  
the vehicle’s seat belt, fully in accordance with the  
child seat manufacturer’s instructions.  
Important!  
Laws in most states and all Canadian provinces require  
seat belt use.  
All states and provinces require use of child restraints  
that comply with U.S. Federal Motor Vehicle Safety  
Standard 213 and Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety  
Standard 213.  
A child’s risk of serious or fatal injuries is  
significantly increased if the child restraints are  
not properly secured in the vehicle and the child is  
not properly secured in the child restraint.  
All child restraint systems are designed to be secured in  
vehicle seats by lap belts or the lap belt portion of a lap-  
shoulder belt.  
For your safety and that of your passengers we strongly  
recommend their use.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Warning!  
Warning!  
Never ride in a moving vehicle with the backrest  
reclined. Sitting in an excessively reclined position  
can be dangerous. You could slide under the seat  
belt in a collision. If you slide under it, the belt  
would apply force at the abdomen or neck. That  
could cause serious or even fatal injuries. The  
backrest and seat belt provide the best restraint  
when the wearer is in an upright position and the  
belt is properly positioned on the body.  
Failure to wear and properly fasten and position  
your seat belt greatly increases your risk of  
injuries and their likely severity in an accident.  
You and your passengers should always wear seat  
belts.  
If you are ever in an accident, your injuries can be  
considerably more severe without your seat belt  
properly buckled. Without your seat belt buckled,  
you are much more likely to hit the interior of the  
vehicle or be ejected from it. You can be seriously  
injured or killed.  
Note:  
For cleaning and care of the seat belts, see page 306.  
In the same crash, the possibility for injury or  
death is lessened if you are wearing your seat belt.  
Seat belt nonusage warning system  
Warning!  
With the electronic key in steering lock position 2, a  
warning sounds for a short time if the driver’s seat belt  
is not fastened. See also seat belt warning lamp on  
page 232.  
Never let more people ride in the vehicle than there  
are seat belts available. Be sure everyone riding in  
the vehicle is correctly restrained with a separate  
seat belt.  
Restraint systems  
59  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
60  
Fastening of seat belts  
Push latch plate (1) into buckle (2) until it clicks. Do not  
twist the belt. A twisted seat belt may cause injury.  
To help avoid severe or fatal injuries, the lap belt must  
be positioned as low as possible on your hips and not  
across the abdomen.  
Warning!  
1
Always fasten your seat belt before driving off.  
Always make sure your passengers are properly  
restrained – even those sitting in the rear.  
3
2
1 Latch plate  
2 Buckle  
3 Release button  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Unfastening of seat belts  
1
3
2
P91.40-2102-26  
Tighten the lap portion to a snug fit by pulling shoulder  
portion up.  
Push the release button (3) in the belt buckle (2). Allow  
the retractor to completely rewind the seat belt by  
guiding the latch plate (1).  
The shoulder portion of the seat belt must be pulled  
snug and checked for snugness immediately after  
engaging it.  
Operation  
The inertia reel stops the belt from unwinding during  
sudden vehicle stops or when quickly pulling on the  
belt. The locking function of the reel may be checked by  
quickly pulling out the belt.  
Adjust seat belt so that shoulder portion is located as  
close as possible to the middle of your shoulder (it  
should not touch the neck).  
Restraint systems  
61  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
62  
Caution!  
• Never wear belts over rigid or breakable  
objects in or on your clothing, such as  
eyeglasses, pens, keys etc., as these might  
cause injuries.  
For safety reasons, avoid adjusting the seat or backrest  
into positions which could affect the correct seat belt  
position.  
• Never wear the shoulder belt under your arm,  
against your neck or off your shoulder. In a  
crash, your body would move too far forward.  
That would increase the chance of head and  
neck injuries. The belt would also apply too  
much force to the ribs or abdomen, which  
could severely injure internal organs such as  
your liver or spleen.  
Warning!  
USE SEAT BELTS PROPERLY.  
• Seat belts can only work when used properly.  
Never wear seat belts in any other way than as  
described in this section, as that could result  
in serious injuries in case of an accident.  
• Each occupant should wear their seat belt at all  
times, because seat belts help reduce the  
likelihood of and potential severity of injuries  
in accidents, including rollovers. The  
• Position the lap belt as low as possible on your  
hips and not across the abdomen. If the belt is  
positioned across your abdomen, it could cause  
serious injuries in a crash.  
integrated restraint system includes “SRS”  
(driver airbag, front passenger airbag, door  
mounted side impact airbags), “ETR” (seat belt  
emergency tensioning retractors), and front  
seat knee bolsters. The system is designed to  
enhance the protection offered to properly  
belted occupants in certain frontal (front  
airbags) and side (side impact airbags) impacts  
which exceed preset deployment thresholds.  
• Each seat belt should never be used for more  
than one person at a time. Do not fasten a seat  
belt around a person and another person or  
other objects.  
• Belts should not be worn twisted. In a crash,  
you wouldn’t have the full width of the belt to  
manage impact forces. The twisted belt against  
your body could cause injuries.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
• Pregnant women should also use a lap-  
shoulder belt. The lap belt portion should be  
positioned as low as possible on the hips to  
avoid any possible pressure on the abdomen.  
According to accident statistics, children are safer  
when properly restrained in the rear seating  
positions than in the front seating positions.  
Infants and small children must ride in back seats  
and be seated in an appropriate infant or child  
restraint system, which is properly secured with  
the vehicle’s seat belt, fully in accordance with the  
child seat manufacturer’s instructions.  
• Never place your feet on the instrument panel  
or on the seat. Always keep both feet on the  
floor in front of the seat.  
A child’s risk of serious or fatal injuries is  
significantly increased if the child restraints are  
not properly secured in the vehicle and the child is  
not properly secured in the child restraint.  
Warning!  
USE CHILD RESTRAINTS PROPERLY.  
Children 12 years old and under must never ride in  
the front seat, except in a Mercedes-Benz  
authorized BabySmartTM compatible child seat,  
which operates with the BabySmartTM system  
installed in the vehicle to deactivate the passenger  
front airbag when it is properly installed.  
Otherwise they will be struck by the airbag when it  
inflates in a crash. If this happens, serious or fatal  
injury will result.  
Children too big for child restraint systems must  
ride in back seats using regular seat belts. Position  
shoulder belt across chest and shoulder, not face or  
neck. A booster seat may be necessary to achieve  
proper belt positioning.  
Restraint systems  
63  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
64  
BabySmartTM airbag deactivation system  
The passenger side front airbag will not deploy  
only if the 7 indicator lamp remains  
illuminated.  
Special BabySmartTM compatible child seats, designed  
for use with the Mercedes-Benz system and available at  
any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center are required for  
use with the BabySmartTM airbag deactivation system.  
Please be sure to check the indicator every time  
you use the special system child seat.  
Should the light go out while the restraint is  
installed, please check installation. If the light  
remains out, do not use the BabySmartTM restraint  
to transport children on the front passenger seat  
until the system has been repaired.  
With the special child seat properly installed, the  
passenger front airbag will not deploy. The 7  
indicator lamp located on the center console will be  
illuminated, except with electronic key removed or in  
steering lock position 0. The system does not deactivate  
the door mounted side impact airbag.  
Self-test BabySmartTM  
without special child seat installed  
BabySmartTM is a trademark of Siemens Automotive Corp.  
After turning electronic key in steering lock to  
position 1 or 2, the 7 indicator lamp located on the  
center console comes on for approx. 6 seconds and then  
extinguishes.  
Warning!  
The BabySmartTM airbag deactivation system will  
ONLY work with a special child seat designed to  
operate with it. It will not work with child seats  
which are not BabySmartTM compatible.  
If the indicator lamp should not come on or is  
continuously lit, the system is not functioning. You must  
see an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center before seating  
any child on the front passenger seat.  
Never place anything between seat cushion and  
child seat (e.g. pillow), since it reduces the  
effectiveness of the deactivation system.  
Follow the manufacturer’s instructions for  
installation of special child seats.  
BabySmartTM is a trademark of Siemens Automotive Corp.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Supplemental restraint system (SRS)  
Emergency tensioning retractor (ETR)  
Airbags are intended as a supplement to seat belts.  
Airbags alone cannot protect as well as airbags plus  
seat belts in impacts for which the airbags were  
designed to operate, and do not afford any protection  
whatsoever in crashes for which the airbags are not  
designed to deploy.  
The seat belts for the front seats are equipped with  
emergency tensioning retractors. These tensioning  
retractors are located in each belt’s inertia reel and  
become operationally ready with the electronic key in  
steering lock position 1 or 2.  
The emergency tensioning retractors are designed to  
activate only when the seat belts are fastened during  
frontal impacts exceeding the first threshold of the SRS  
and in rear impacts exceeding a preset severity level.  
They remove slack from the belts in such a way that the  
seat belts fit more snugly against the body restricting its  
forward movement as much as possible.  
The SRS uses two crash severity levels (thresholds) to  
activate either the emergency tensioning retractor (ETR)  
or front airbag or both. Activation depends on the  
direction and severity of the impact exceeding the  
preset thresholds and whether the seat belt is fastened.  
Seat belt fastened  
In cases of other frontal impacts, angled impacts,  
roll-overs, certain side impacts, or other accidents  
without sufficient frontal or rear impact forces, the  
emergency tensioning retractors will not be activated.  
The driver and passengers will then be protected by the  
fastened seat belts and inertia reel in the usual manner.  
first threshold exceeded: ETR activates  
second threshold exceeded: airbag also activates  
Seat belt not fastened  
first threshold exceeded:  
For seat belt and emergency tensioning retractor safety  
guidelines see page 72.  
airbag activates, but not ETR  
Driver and front passenger systems operate  
independently of each other.  
Restraint systems  
65  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
66  
Airbags  
2
SRS  
SRS  
AIRBAG  
AIRBAG  
1
1 Driver airbag  
2 Front passenger airbag  
The driver airbag is located in the steering wheel hub.  
The passenger front airbag is located in the dashboard  
ahead of the front passenger.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
mounted side impact airbags can provide increased  
protection to belted front passengers on the impacted  
side of the vehicle in side impacts exceeding its preset  
threshold.  
Important!  
3
The operational readiness of the airbag system is  
verified by the indicator lamp “SRS” in the instrument  
cluster when turning the electronic key in steering lock  
to position 1 or 2. If no fault is detected, the lamp will go  
out after approximately 4 seconds; after the lamp goes  
out, the system continues to monitor the components  
and circuitry of the airbag system and will indicate a  
malfunction by coming on again. If the lamp does not  
come on at all or if it fails to extinguish after  
P91.60-2122-26  
3 Side impact airbag  
approximately 4 seconds or if it comes on thereafter,  
a malfunction in the system has been detected.  
The side impact airbags are located in the doors.  
The most effective occupant restraint system yet  
developed for use in production vehicles is the seat belt.  
In some cases, however, the protective effect of a seat  
belt can be further enhanced by an airbag.  
The following system components are monitored or  
undergo a self-check: crash-sensor(s), airbag ignition  
circuits, front seat belt buckles, emergency tensioning  
retractors, seat sensor.  
In conjunction with wearing the seat belts, the driver  
and front passenger airbags can provide increased  
protection for the driver and front passenger in certain  
frontal impacts exceeding preset thresholds. Door  
Restraint systems  
67  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Front airbags  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
68  
Initially, when the electronic key is turned from steering  
lock position 0 to positions 1 or 2, malfunctions in the  
crash-sensor are detected and indicated (the “SRS”  
indicator lamp stays on longer than 4 seconds or does  
not come on).  
The driver and front passenger front airbags are  
designed to activate only in certain frontal impacts  
exceeding a preset threshold.  
The front passenger airbag deploys only if the front  
passenger seat is occupied and the indicator lamp on  
the center console is not illuminated.  
Have the system checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center immediately.  
In the operational mode, after the indicator lamp has  
gone out following the initial check, interruptions or  
short circuits in the airbag ignition circuit and in the  
driver and front passenger seat belt buckle harnesses,  
and low voltage in the entire system are detected and  
indicated.  
Note:  
Heavy objects on the front passenger seat can appear to  
the “SRS” to indicate the presence of an occupant in  
that seat which causes the passenger front airbag to  
deploy in a crash exceeding the appropriate threshold.  
Warning!  
In the event a malfunction of the “SRS” is indicated  
as outlined above, the “SRS” may not be  
operational. For your safety, we strongly  
recommend that you visit an authorized Mercedes-  
Benz Center immediately to have the system  
checked; otherwise the “SRS” may not be activated  
when needed in an accident, which could result in  
serious or fatal injury, or it might deploy  
unexpectedly and unnecessarily which could also  
result in injury.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Side impact airbags  
Important!  
The side impact airbags are designed to activate only in  
certain side impacts exceeding a preset threshold. Only  
the side impact airbag on the impacted side of the  
vehicle deploys.  
Airbags are designed to activate only in certain  
frontal (front airbags) impacts, or side (side impact  
airbags) impacts which exceed preset thresholds.  
Only during these types of impacts, if of sufficient  
severity to meet the deployment thresholds, will  
they provide their supplemental protection.  
The side impact airbag for the front passenger deploys  
only if the front passenger seat is occupied.  
Side impact airbags operate best in conjunction with a  
properly positioned and fastened seat belt.  
The driver and passenger should always wear their  
seat belts, otherwise it is not possible for the airbags  
to provide their intended supplemental protection.  
Note:  
In cases of other frontal impacts, angled impacts,  
roll-overs, other side impacts, rear collisions, or  
other accidents in which the airbags are not  
designed to deploy, the airbags will not be activated.  
The driver and passenger will then be protected by  
the fastened seat belts.  
Heavy objects on front passenger seat can cause the  
side impact airbag to deploy in a crash.  
We caution you not to rely on the presence of the  
airbags in order to avoid wearing your seat belt.  
Restraint systems  
69  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
70  
Your vehicle was originally equipped with airbags  
which are designed to activate in certain impacts  
exceeding a preset threshold to reduce the potential  
and severity of injury. It is important to your safety  
and that of your passengers that you replace  
deployed airbags and repair any malfunctioning  
airbags to ensure the vehicle will continue to  
provide crash protection for occupants.  
Warning!  
Airbags are designed to reduce the potential of  
injury in certain frontal (front airbags) impacts,  
and side (side impact airbags) impacts which may  
cause significant injuries, however, no system  
available today can totally eliminate injuries and  
fatalities.  
The activation of the “SRS” temporarily releases a  
small amount of dust from the airbags. This dust,  
however, is neither injurious to your health, nor  
does it indicate a fire in the vehicle. The dust might  
cause some temporary breathing difficulty for  
people with asthma or other breathing trouble. To  
avoid this, you may wish to get out of the vehicle as  
soon as it is safe to do so. If you have any breathing  
difficulty but cannot get out of the vehicle after the  
airbag inflates, then get fresh air by opening a  
window or door.  
Warning!  
To reduce the risk of injury when the front airbags  
inflate, it is very important for the driver and front  
passenger to always be in a properly seated  
position and to wear their seat belts.  
For maximum protection in the event of a collision  
always be in normal seated position with your back  
against the backrest. Fasten your seat belt and  
ensure that it is properly positioned on your body.  
Since the airbag inflates with considerable speed  
and force, a proper seating and hands on steering  
wheel position will help to keep you at a safe  
distance from the airbag. Occupants who are  
unbelted, out of position or too close to the airbag  
can be seriously injured by an airbag as it inflates  
with great force in the blink of an eye:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
• Sit properly belted in an upright position with  
your back against the backrest.  
• Occupants, especially children, should never  
lean their heads in the area of the door where  
the side airbag inflates. This could result in  
serious injuries or death should the airbag be  
triggered. Always sit upright, properly use the  
seat belts, and appropriate size infant or child  
restraint system.  
• Adjust the driver seat as far as possible  
rearward, still permitting proper operation of  
vehicle controls. The distance from the center  
of the driver’s breastbone to the center of the  
airbag cover on the steering wheel must be at  
least ten inches (25 cm) or more. You should be  
able to accomplish this by a combination of  
adjustments to the seat and steering wheel. If  
you have any problems, please see your  
• Children 12 years old and under must never  
ride in the front seat, except in a  
Mercedes-Benz authorized BabySmartTM  
compatible child seat, which operates with the  
BabySmartTM system installed in the vehicle to  
deactivate the passenger front airbag when it  
is properly installed. Otherwise they will be  
struck by the airbag when it inflates in a crash.  
If this happens, serious or fatal injury can  
result.  
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
• Do not lean with your head or chest close to the  
steering wheel or dashboard.  
• Keep hands on the outside of steering wheel  
rim. Placing hands and arms inside the rim  
can increase the risk and potential severity of  
hand/arm injury when the driver front airbag  
inflates.  
Failure to follow these instructions can result in  
severe or fatal injuries to you or other occupants.  
• Adjust the front passenger seat as far as  
possible rearward from the dashboard when  
the seat is occupied.  
Restraint systems  
71  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
72  
Safety guidelines for the seat belt,  
emergency tensioning retractor and airbag  
Warning!  
Accident research shows that the safest place for  
children in an automobile is in the rear seat.  
Should you choose to place a child 12 years old or  
under in the front passenger seat of your vehicle,  
you must properly use a BabySmartTM child  
restraint which will turn off the passenger side  
front airbag. BabySmartTM will not, however, turn  
off the passenger’s side impact airbag.  
Warning!  
• Damaged seat belts or belts that were highly  
stressed in an accident must be replaced and  
their anchoring points must also be checked.  
Use only belts installed or supplied by an  
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
It should be noted however that there is a  
possibility for a side airbag related injury if  
occupants, especially children, are not properly  
seated or restrained when next to a side airbag  
which needs to deploy rapidly in a side impact in  
order to do its job.  
• Do not pass belts over sharp edges.  
• Do not make any modification that could  
change the effectiveness of the belts.  
• Airbags and ETR’s are designed to function on  
a one-time-only basis. An airbag or emergency  
tensioning retractor (ETR) that was activated  
must be replaced.  
To help avoid the possibility of injury, please follow  
these guidelines: (1) occupants, especially  
children, should never place their bodies or lean  
their heads in the area of the door where the side  
airbag inflates. This could result in serious  
injuries or death should the side airbag be  
activated; (2) always sit upright, properly use the  
seat belts and use an appropriately sized infant or  
child restraint system for all children 12 years old  
or under; and (3) always wear seat belts properly.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
• No modifications of any kind may be made to  
any components or wiring of the “SRS”. This  
includes changing or removing any component  
or part of the “SRS”, the installation of  
additional trim material, badges etc. over the  
steering wheel hub, front passenger airbag  
cover, or front door trim panels, and  
• For your protection and the protection of  
others, when scrapping the airbag unit or  
emergency tensioning retractor, our safety  
instructions must be followed. These  
instructions are available at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center.  
• Given the considerable deployment speed and  
the textile structure of the airbags, there is the  
possibility of abrasions or other injuries  
resulting from airbag deployment.  
installation of additional electrical/electronic  
equipment on or near “SRS” components and  
wiring. Keep area between airbags and  
occupants free of objects (e.g. packages,  
purses, umbrellas, etc.).  
When you sell the vehicle we strongly urge you to give  
notice to the subsequent owner that it is equipped with  
an “SRS” by alerting him to the applicable section in the  
Operator’s Manual.  
• An airbag system component within the  
steering wheel gets hot after the airbag has  
inflated. Do not touch.  
• Improper work on the system, including  
incorrect installation and removal, can lead to  
possible injury through an unintended  
activation of the “SRS”.  
• In addition, through improper work there is  
the risk of rendering the “SRS” inoperative or  
causing unintended airbag deployment. Work  
on the “SRS” must therefore only be performed  
by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Restraint systems  
73  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Important!  
Car care  
Index  
Restraint systems  
74  
Infant and child restraint systems  
We recommend all infants and children be properly re-  
strained at all times while the vehicle is in motion. All  
lap-shoulder belts except the driver’s seat belt have  
special seat belt retractors for secure fastening of child  
restraints.  
The use of infant or child restraints is required by law in  
all 50 states and all Canadian provinces.  
Infants and small children should be seated in an  
appropriate infant or child restraint system properly  
secured by a lap-shoulder belt, and that complies with  
U.S. Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213 and  
Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213.  
A statement by the child restraint manufacturer of  
compliance with this standard can be found on the  
instruction label on the restraint and in the instruction  
manual provided with the restraint.  
To activate, pull shoulder belt out completely and let it  
retract. During the seat belt retraction a ratcheting  
sound can be heard to indicate that the special seat belt  
retractor is activated. The belt is now locked.  
To deactivate, release seat belt buckle and let seat belt  
retract completely. The seat belt can again be used in  
the usual manner.  
When using any infant or child restraint system, be sure  
to carefully read and follow all manufacturer’s  
instructions for installation and use.  
Warning!  
Please read and observe warning labels affixed to inside  
of vehicle and to infant or child restraints.  
Never release the seat belt buckle while vehicle is  
in motion, since the special seat belt retractor will  
be deactivated.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Warning!  
Children too big for child restraint systems must  
ride in back seats using regular seat belts. Position  
shoulder belt across chest and shoulder, not face or  
neck. A booster seat may be necessary to achieve  
proper belt positioning for children from 41 lbs. to  
the point where a lap/shoulder belt fits properly  
without one.  
Children 12 years old and under must never ride in  
the front seat, except in a Mercedes-Benz  
authorized BabySmartTM compatible child seat,  
which operates with the BabySmartTM system  
installed in the vehicle to deactivate the passenger  
front airbag when it is properly installed.  
Otherwise they will be struck by the airbag when it  
inflates in a crash. If this happens, serious or fatal  
injury can result.  
When the child restraint is not in use, remove it  
from the vehicle or secure it with the seat belt to  
prevent the child restraint from becoming a  
projectile in the event of an accident.  
According to accident statistics, children are safer  
when properly restrained in the rear seating  
positions than in the front seating positions.  
Infants and small children must ride in back seats  
and be seated in an appropriate infant or child  
restraint system, which is properly secured with  
the vehicle’s seat belt, fully in accordance with the  
child seat manufacturer’s instructions.  
Infants and small children should never share a  
seat belt with another occupant. During an  
accident, they could be crushed between the  
occupant and seat belt.  
Restraint systems  
75  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Adjusting telescoping steering column  
Adjusting telescoping steering column  
76  
Unlocking:  
Pull handle (1) out to its stop. The indicator lamp,  
located in the instrument cluster, comes on.  
Adjusting:  
To lengthen or shorten the steering column, pull out or  
push in steering wheel.  
Locking:  
Push handle (1) in until it engages. The indicator lamp,  
located in the instrument cluster, goes out.  
1
Important!  
With the electronic key in steering lock position 2, the  
indicator lamp in the instrument cluster comes on.  
It should go out when the engine is running.  
P46.10-2020-26  
If the indicator lamp does not go out after starting the  
engine, the adjustable steering column is not locked  
properly.  
Warning!  
Do not adjust the steering wheel while driving.  
The telescoping adjustment must be locked while  
driving. Adjusting the steering wheel while  
driving, or driving without the telescoping  
adjustment locked could cause the driver to lose  
control of the vehicle.  
Do not drive the vehicle until you have properly locked  
the steering column.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Inside rear view mirror  
Note:  
Manually adjust the mirror.  
The automatic antiglare function does not react, if  
incoming light is not aimed directly at sensors in the  
mirror.  
Use your inside mirror to determine the size and  
distance of objects seen in the passenger side convex  
mirror.  
Warning!  
In the case of an accident liquid electrolyte may  
escape the mirror housing when the mirror glass  
breaks.  
Antiglare night position  
With the electronic key in steering lock position 2, the  
mirror reflection brightness responds to changes in  
light sensitivity.  
Electrolyte has an irritating effect. Do not allow the  
liquid come into contact with eyes, skin, clothing,  
or respiratory system. In cases it does, immediately  
flush affected area with water, and seek medical  
help if necessary.  
With gear selector lever in position “R”, or with the  
interior lamp switched on, the mirror brightness does  
not respond to changes in light sensitivity.  
Rear view mirrors  
77  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
     
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Rear view mirrors  
Exterior rear view mirrors  
78  
With the electronic key in steering lock position 2, the  
driver’s side mirror reflection brightness responds to  
changes in light sensitivity.  
With gear selector lever in position “R”, or with the  
interior lamp switched on, the driver’s side mirror  
brightness does not respond to changes in light  
sensitivity.  
Warning!  
Exercise care when using the passenger-side  
mirror. The passenger-side exterior mirror is  
convex (outwardly curved surface for a wider field  
of view). Objects in mirror are closer than they  
appear. Check your inside rear view mirror or  
glance over your shoulder before changing lanes.  
The switch is located on the center console.  
Turn electronic key in steering lock to position 2.  
First select the mirror to be adjusted – press button:  
% Left mirror  
Notes:  
The exterior mirrors have electrically heated glass. The  
heater switches on automatically, depending on outside  
temperature.  
& Right mirror  
If an exterior mirror housing is forcibly pivoted from its  
normal position, it must be repositioned by applying  
firm pressure until it snaps into place.  
To adjust, toggle the switch forward, backward or to  
either side.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Storing mirror positions in memory  
Warning!  
The exterior rear view mirror positions are stored in  
memory with the seat/head restraint position and can  
be recalled when necessary, see page 48.  
In the case of an accident liquid electrolyte may  
escape the mirror housing when the mirror glass  
breaks.  
Electrolyte has an irritating effect. Do not allow the  
liquid come into contact with eyes, skin, clothing,  
or respiratory system. In cases it does, immediately  
flush affected area with water, and seek medical  
help if necessary.  
Important!  
Electrolyte drops coming into contact with the vehicle  
paint finish can only be completely removed while in  
their liquid state, by applying plenty of water.  
Rear view mirrors  
79  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Rear view mirrors  
Parking position  
80  
The mirror position can now be adjusted as desired.  
At speeds above approx. 6 mph (10 km/h), upon shifting  
gear selector lever from “R” Reverse, or upon pressing  
the driver’s side mirror button, the passenger-side  
mirror will return to its previous position.  
The passenger-side exterior mirror can be adjusted and  
programmed to assist the driver during parking  
maneuvers (e.g. to observe the curb or other objects  
close to the vehicle).  
Readjust the mirror as desired.  
With electronic key in steering lock position 2, and the  
exterior rear view mirror switch in the passenger side  
position, the passenger-side mirror will be turned  
downward when placing the gear selector lever in “R”  
Reverse.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
One passenger-side mirror position can be stored in  
memory. To do so:  
3. Press green memory button located in switch cluster  
for driver seat, see page 48.  
4. Within 3 seconds pull the mirror toggle switch  
rearward. The mirror should not move.  
1. Turn electronic key to steering lock position 2.  
The vehicle must be stationary.  
Repeat the memory procedure if the mirror moves.  
2. Select passenger-side mirror and adjust the mirror  
to view the curb.  
5. Select driver side mirror. The passenger-side mirror  
will return to its previous position.  
Rear view mirrors  
81  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Instrument cluster  
Instrument cluster  
82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1 Push buttons V and W for intensity of instrument  
8 Speedometer  
lamps, see page 85  
9 Trip odometer, see page 87  
10 Main odometer  
2 Push button J for resetting trip odometer, see  
page 87, or to acknowledge a malfunction or  
warning message, see page 104.  
11 Multifunction indicator, see page 88  
or FSS indicator, see page 109  
3 Coolant temperature gauge, see page 86  
or engine oil level indicator, see page 112  
4 Fuel gauge with reserve and fuel cap placement  
12 Right turn signal indicator lamp, see combination  
warning lamp, see page 230  
switch on page 117  
5 Outside temperature indicator, see page 86  
13 Tachometer, see page 87  
6 Left turn signal indicator lamp, see combination  
14 Gear range indicator display, see selector lever  
switch on page 117  
positions on page 198  
7 ESP warning lamp, see page 231  
15 Clock, see page 106  
Instrument cluster  
83  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Instrument cluster  
Indicator lamps in the instrument cluster  
Telescoping steering column not locked,  
see page 232  
High beam  
SRS malfunction, see page 230  
SRS  
ABS malfunction, see page 231  
ABS  
If the “CHECK ENGINE” malfunction  
indicator lamp comes on when the engine is  
running, it indicates a malfunction of the  
fuel management system, emission control  
system, systems which impact emissions, or  
the fuel cap is not closed tight. In all cases,  
we recommend that you have the  
CHECK  
ENGINE  
Brake fluid low (except Canada),  
see page 229  
Parking brake engaged, see page 229  
BRAKE  
Brake fluid low (Canada only),  
see page 229  
Parking brake engaged, see page 229  
malfunction checked as soon as possible,  
see page 228.  
BAS malfunction, see page 231  
ESP malfunction, see page 231 and 245  
BAS  
ESP  
Function indicator lamp on the center console  
ESP. Adjust driving to road condition,  
see page 220  
Front passenger airbag automatically  
switched off, see page 64.  
Fasten seat belts, see page 232  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Activating instrument cluster display  
The instrument cluster is activated by:  
Opening the door.  
Instrument lamps  
Pressing button J, V or W on the instrument  
cluster.  
Turning the electronic key in steering lock to  
position 1 or 2.  
Switching on the exterior lamps.  
Display illumination  
The display for temperature, odometer, multifunction  
indicator, FSS indicator and clock is illuminated briefly  
when opening the driver’s door.  
P54.30-2767-26  
Activate the instrument cluster.  
The display illumination brightness responds  
automatically according to changes in the surrounding  
light sensitivity.  
Press V or W button to vary intensity of instrument  
lamps.  
To briefly illuminate the display (with electronic key  
removed or in steering lock position 0), press button J.  
Instrument cluster  
85  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
       
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Instrument cluster  
Coolant temperature gauge (3)  
86  
Outside temperature indicator (5)  
During severe operating conditions and stop-and-go city  
traffic, the coolant temperature may rise close to the red  
marking.  
The temperature sensor is located in the front bumper  
area. Due to its location, the sensor can be affected by  
road or engine heat during idling or slow driving. This  
means that the accuracy of the displayed temperature  
can only be verified by comparison to a thermometer  
placed next to the sensor, not by comparison to external  
displays (e.g. bank signs etc.).  
The engine should not be operated with the coolant  
temperature in the red zone. Doing so may cause  
serious engine damage which is not covered by the  
Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Adaptation to ambient temperature takes place in steps  
and depends on the prevailing driving conditions (stop-  
and-go or moderate, constant driving) and amount of  
temperature change.  
Warning!  
• Driving when your engine is badly overheated  
can cause some fluids which may have leaked  
into the engine compartment to catch fire. You  
could be seriously burned.  
Warning!  
The outside temperature indicator is not designed  
to serve as an Ice-Warning Device and is therefore  
unsuitable for that purpose. Indicated  
temperatures just above the freezing point do not  
guarantee that the road surface is free of ice.  
• Steam from an overheated engine can cause  
serious burns and can occur just by opening  
the engine hood. Stay away from the engine if  
you see or hear steam coming from it.  
Turn off the engine, get out of the vehicle and do  
not stand near the vehicle until it cools down.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Trip odometer (9)  
Tachometer (13)  
To reset to “0” miles/km:  
The red marking on tachometer denotes excessive  
engine speed.  
Activate the instrument cluster if it is not already  
activated by pressing the J button on the instrument  
cluster.  
Avoid this engine speed, as it may result in serious  
engine damage that is not covered by the  
Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Press button è or ÿ on the multifunction  
steering wheel repeatedly until the trip odometer  
appears if it is not displayed. See page 92.  
To help protect the engine, the fuel supply is interrupted  
if the engine is operated within the red marking.  
Press button J on the instrument cluster to reset trip  
odometer.  
Instrument cluster  
87  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
       
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Depending on your vehicle’s equipment, you may use  
the buttons on the multifunction steering wheel to call  
up, control and set the following systems in the  
multifunction display:  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until the  
required system is displayed.  
Pressing the è button advances the display to the  
next system.  
Pressing the ÿ button returns the display to the  
previous system.  
1 Trip odometer and main odometer, see page 92  
Vehicle speed, see page 92  
Flexible service system (FSS), see page 109  
Engine oil level indicator, see page 112  
You may call up additional displays within some of these  
categories by pressing the j or k button.  
2 Audio systems, see page 93  
Warning!  
Radio, see page 93  
A driver’s attention to the road must always be his/  
her primary focus when driving.  
CD player (optional), see page 94  
Cassette player, see page 95  
For your safety and the safety of others, selecting  
features through the multifunction steering wheel  
should only be done by the driver when traffic and  
road conditions permit it to be done safely.  
Programming individual settings in the system can  
only be made while the vehicle is at standstill.  
3 Navigation system (optional), see page 101  
4 Malfunction message memory, see page 104  
5 Individual settings, see page 106  
6 Trip computer, see page 102  
After start  
After reset  
Fuel tank content  
7 Telephone (if so equipped), see page 96  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
89  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
90  
Turn the electronic key in steering look to position 1  
or 2.  
1
Press button:  
3 è for next system  
2
4 ÿ for previous system  
OFF  
RESUME  
5 j for next display in system  
6 k for previous display in system  
7 æ to increase the volume  
8 ç to decrease the volume  
9 í to dial a telephone number, see page 96  
5
6
8
7  
10  
4
9
3
See page 100 for instructions on answering an  
incoming call.  
TEL  
10 ì to end a call  
1 Multifunction steering wheel  
2 Multifunction display  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until the  
Note:  
required system is displayed.  
The displays in the multifunction display can be set to  
German, English, French, Italian or Spanish language.  
See the “TEXT” individual setting on page 106 for  
instructions on changing the language setting.  
Pressing the è button advances the display to the  
next system.  
Pressing the ÿ button returns the display to the  
previous system.  
The displays for the audio systems (radio, CD player,  
cassette player) will appear in English, regardless of the  
language selected.  
You may call up additional displays in some systems by  
pressing the j or k button.  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
91  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
92  
Trip and main odometer, vehicle speed, FSS and  
engine oil level indicator  
1 Trip odometer and main odometer  
See page 87 for instructions on resetting the trip  
odometer.  
2 Vehicle speed  
3 FSS (Flexible service system), see page 109.  
4 Engine oil level indicator, see page 112.  
Press è or ÿ button repeatedly until the trip  
odometer and main odometer display (1) appears.  
Press the j or k button repeatedly until the  
required display (2, 3, 4, 1) appears.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Audio systems  
Radio  
1 Audio system is switched off.  
2 The radio is switched on.  
3 Wave band setting and memory location number,  
where appropriate.  
4 Station frequency.  
5 This only appears when “MEMORY” rather than  
“FREQUENCY” has been selected in the individual  
settings. See page 106.  
The radio must be switched on.  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until  
display (2) appears.  
Press button j or k repeatedly until the required  
station or frequency is displayed.  
Use the j of k button to select a stored station or  
station frequency. This depends on the selection made  
in the “STATION SEARCH USING” setting menu.  
See page 106.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
P54.30-2936-27  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
93  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
       
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
94  
CD player (optional)  
1 Audio system is switched off.  
2 The CD player is switched on.  
3 The number of the CD currently playing is displayed  
if you are using a CD changer.  
4 Track number.  
The radio must be switched on.  
The CD player must be switched on.  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until  
display (2) appears.  
Press the j or k button repeatedly until the  
required track number (4) is displayed.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
Note:  
To select a CD from the magazine, press a number on  
the audio system or the (optional) COMAND system key  
pad located in the center dashboard.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Cassette player  
1 Audio system is switched off.  
2 The cassette player is switched on.  
3 Side being played.  
The radio must be switched on.  
The cassette player must be switched on.  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until  
display (2) appears.  
Pressing the j button fast forwards on to the next  
track.  
Pressing the k button rewinds the cassette to the  
beginning of the current track.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
Note:  
To select the reverse side of the tape, press button below  
track number on the audio system display, or enter  
request on the (optional) COMAND system located in  
the center dashboard.  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
95  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
96  
Telephone  
1 The telephone is switched off.  
Telephone book  
2 The vehicle is currently outside the transmitter or  
receiver range.  
3 The telephone is ready for use.  
4 Name selected from the telephone book.  
5 Number for the name selected. Dialing commences.  
6 Dialing is completed. The name is displayed. The  
display remains for the duration of the call.  
7 Duration of call.  
8
8 Memory location number.  
P54.30-3578-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
The telephone must be switched on.  
Press the í button when the name you require  
appears in the display (4). The telephone number (5) is  
dialed.  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until the  
display (3) appears. Refer to the separate telephone  
instruction manual.  
The name will be displayed when dialing is completed.  
Display (6) remains for the duration of the call.  
Pressing j or k “browses” alphabetically  
forwards or backwards through the telephone book,  
providing it was previously downloaded. See telephone  
operator’s manual for details concerning downloading.  
Pressing button j or k for longer than a second  
“browses” rapidly through the telephone book.  
The name selected appears in the display.  
Pressing the ì button hangs up and display (3)  
appears.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
Note:  
Press the ì button if you do not wish to make a call.  
The procedure is cancelled and display (3) appears.  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
97  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
Redialing  
98  
1 The telephone is ready for use.  
2 Number or name stored in the redial memory.  
3 Number in the redial memory – redialing has  
commenced.  
4 Dialing is completed and the name stored in the  
telephone book is displayed or the number dialed  
will remain displayed if no name has been stored.  
The display remains for the duration of the call.  
5 Duration of call.  
6 Memory location numbers — the 10 most recently  
dialed numbers are stored.  
L0, most recently dialed number,  
L1 to L9, previously dialed numbers.  
P54.30-3580-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
The telephone must be switched on.  
Press the í button when the required number or  
name appears in the display (2).  
The telephone number (3) is dialed.  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until the  
display (1) appears.  
Once dialing is completed the name (4) is displayed if  
the name is stored in the telephone book; failing that  
the number dialed will remain displayed. The display  
remains for the duration of the call.  
Pressing the í button activates the redial memory  
and the most recently dialed number is displayed.  
Pressing the j or k button “browses” forwards or  
backwards through the redial memory. The number  
selected appears in the display.  
Pressing the ì button hangs up and display (1)  
appears.  
Note:  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
Press the ì button if you do not wish to make a call.  
The procedure is cancelled and display (1) appears.  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
99  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
100  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
Incoming call  
1 “CALL” — you are being called  
Press the í button to answer the call.  
Press the ì button to hang up or if you do not wish  
to answer the incoming call.  
The telephone must be switched on.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Navigation system (optional)  
1 The navigation system is switched off.  
2 The navigation system is switched on but no  
destination has been specified.  
3 The navigation system is switched on and  
destination guidance is active.  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until the  
required system is displayed.  
See the separate COMAND (Cockpit Management and  
Data System) operator’s manual for notes on the  
navigation system.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
P54.30-2985-27  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
101  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
102  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
Trip computer  
1 “AFTER START” – trip odometer records distance  
from first engine start after more than five hours of  
electronic key not being in steering lock position 2  
2 “AFTER RESET” – trip odometer records distance  
from first engine start until reset  
3 Estimated driving range remaining and fuel tank  
contents  
4 Distance covered “AFTER START” respectively  
“AFTER RESET”  
5 Elapsed time “AFTER START” respectively  
“AFTER RESET”  
6 Average speed “AFTER START” respectively  
“AFTER RESET”  
7 Average fuel consumption “AFTER START”  
respectively “AFTER RESET”  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Press the button è or ÿ repeatedly until the  
display (1) appears.  
To reset the “AFTER START” (1) or “AFTER RESET” (2)  
odometer memory at any time:  
Press the j or k button until the display for trip  
odometer memory “AFTER START” (1) and  
“AFTER RESET” (2), or the display (3) for estimated  
driving range remaining and fuel tank contents  
appears.  
Call up the relevant display (1 or 2) using the j or  
k button and press the J button in the instrument  
cluster until the values are reset to “0”.  
The “AFTER START” trip odometer reading is  
automatically reset after four hours of electronic key not  
being in steering lock position 2.  
Important!  
The reading in the display “TANK CONTENT” might be  
off by approximately +/– 2.2 US qt (2 l). Please refuel in  
time.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
Note:  
The “AFTER START” display (1) always appears when  
the trip computer is called up.  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
103  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
104  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
Malfunction message memory  
1 There are no messages stored in the system  
2 Number of messages stored in the system  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until the  
malfunction message memory (1 or 2) is displayed.  
Press the j or k button if display (2) appears.  
The stored malfunction messages will now be displayed  
in order. See page 234 for malfunction and warning  
messages. Display (2) will reappear after you have  
scanned all the malfunction messages.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Should any malfunctions be stored while driving, they  
will reappear in the display (2) when the electronic key  
is in steering lock position 0 or removed from the  
steering lock.  
Important!  
Malfunction and warning messages are only indicated  
for certain systems and displayed to a low level of detail.  
The malfunction and warning messages are simply a  
reminder with respect to the operation of certain  
systems and do not replace the driver’s responsibility to  
maintain the vehicle’s operating safety by having all  
required maintenance and safety checks performed on  
the vehicle and by bringing the vehicle to an authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center to address the malfunction and  
warning messages. See page 228.  
Specific malfunctions can be recalled by pressing  
button J. Each malfunction or warning message must  
be acknowledged by pressing button J. Once all  
messages are cancelled, the odometer display should  
reappear.  
Pressing the J button in the instrument cluster  
immediately switches to the next malfunction message.  
The malfunction message memory will be cleared when  
the electronic key is turned in the steering lock to  
position 1 or 2. Should any subsequent malfunctions  
occur, they will be displayed in the malfunction  
message memory.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
105  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
106  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
Individual settings  
R
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
1 Preliminary display of the individual settings  
8 “STATION SEARCH USING” – radio adjustment  
2 “SET TIME HOURS”  
“FREQUENCY” – use the j or k button to  
select a frequency  
(Only vehicles without COMAND)  
“MEMORY” – use the j or k button to select  
a stored station (preset memory)  
3 “SET TIME MINUTES”  
(Only vehicles without COMAND)  
9 See page 108 for instructions on returning the  
4 “12/24 HOURS” – the unit set is displayed in the  
instrument cluster  
setting menus to the factory settings  
(Only vehicles without COMAND)  
10 Selection marker – indicates the setting selected  
5 “TEMP. INDICATOR” – the unit set is displayed in  
the outside temperature display in the instrument  
cluster and in the automatic air conditioner display  
Notes:  
These settings may only be performed with the vehicle  
at standstill and with the key in steering lock position 1  
or 2.  
6 “DISPLAY VALUES IN” – the unit set is displayed in  
the trip and main odometer  
7 “TEXT” – sets the language used in the  
multifunction display  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
107  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
108  
Car care  
Index  
Multifunction steering wheel, multifunction display  
Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly until the  
To return setting menus (4 to 8) to their factory settings:  
individual setting preliminary display (1) appear.  
Call up the individual setting preliminary  
Press the j or k button until the required setting  
display (1).  
menu (2 to 8) is displayed.  
Press the J button in the instrument cluster for  
Pressing the æ or ç button sets the time in  
setting menus (2, 3) and controls the selection marker  
in setting menus (4 to 8).  
approximately 3 seconds. Display (9) will appear.  
Press the J button once more, the message  
“RESET TO FACTORY SETTINGS” appears in the  
display.  
The settings made are stored and applied immediately.  
The individual setting preliminary display (1) will  
appear again after you have run through all the setting  
menus.  
The individual setting preliminary display (1) will  
appear if you do not press the J button within  
about 5 seconds. The setting menus will not be  
reset.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
Setting the audio volume  
Notes:  
You can only adjust the volume of the system currently  
in use. The volume setting for each system (audio,  
telephone, navigation and voice recognition system) is  
stored separately.  
Settings can only be selected with the vehicle stationary  
or moving slowly.  
The individual setting preliminary display (1) will  
appear if you speed up.  
Setting button:  
The setting menu previously called up will reappear  
when the vehicle stops or slows down, providing no  
other system has been called up in the meantime.  
æ increases the volume.  
ç reduces the volume.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Flexible service system (FSS)  
(service indicator)  
The message is displayed for approx. 10 seconds when  
turning the electronic key in steering lock to position 2,  
or while driving when reaching the service warning  
threshold.  
The symbols and messages indicate the type of service  
to be performed:  
9 Service A  
½ Service B  
10  
One of the following messages will appear in the display  
(e.g. Service A):  
“SERVICE A – IN xx DAYS”  
“SERVICE A – IN xx MILES” (Canada: KM)  
“SERVICE A – EXCEEDED BY xx DAYS”  
“SERVICE A – EXCEEDED BY xx MILES” (Canada: KM)  
“SERVICE A – DUE NOW”  
The FSS permits a flexible service schedule that is  
directly related to the operating conditions of the  
vehicle.  
The next service due date is displayed either in days or  
in miles, depending on your driving style.  
The symbol 9 or ½ appears together with a  
message in the multifunction indicator prior to the next  
suggested service. Depending on operating conditions  
throughout the year, the next service is calculated and  
displayed in days or distance remaining.  
Once the suggested service term has passed, the symbol  
and message appear for approx. 30 seconds and a signal  
sounds every time when turning the electronic key in  
steering lock to position 2.  
Flexible service system  
109  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
110  
Car care  
Index  
Flexible service system  
The service indicator disappears automatically after  
30 seconds or if button J on the instrument cluster is  
pressed.  
Notes:  
When disconnecting vehicle battery for one or more  
days at a time, such days will not be counted. Any such  
days not counted by the FSS can be added by your  
Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Calling up service indicator manually:  
Turn the electronic key in steering lock to position 1.  
The interval between services is determined by the type  
of driving for which the vehicle is used. For example,  
driving at extreme speeds, and cold starts combined  
with short distance driving in which the engine does not  
reach operating normal temperature, reduce the interval  
between services.  
Call up the trip odometer and main odometer, by  
pressing button è or ÿ on the multifunction  
steering wheel until the display appears. See page 92.  
Press button j or k until the FSS indicator  
appears.  
Pressing the è or ÿ button displays the next or  
previous system.  
Important!  
The FSS indicator is not an engine oil level indicator.  
See page 112 for engine oil level indicator.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Following a completed A or B service the  
Mercedes-Benz Center sets the counter mileage to  
10 000 miles (Canada: 15 000 km) and 365 days.  
The multifunction display will show the question:  
“DO YOU WANT TO RESET SERVICE INTERVAL? –  
CONFIRM BY PRESSING R”  
The counter can also be set by any individual. To do so:  
Turn the electronic key in steering lock to position 2.  
Press button J on the instrument cluster again, and  
hold until a signal sounds. The message “SERVICE  
INTERVAL HAS BEEN RESET” appears in the  
multifunction display.  
To call up the trip odometer and main odometer, press  
button è or ÿ on the multifunction steering  
wheel until the display appears. See page 92.  
The new service indicator is displayed with the reset  
distance of 10 000 miles (Canada 15 000 km).  
Press button j or k until the FSS indicator  
appears.  
If the FSS counter was inadvertently reset, have a  
Mercedes-Benz Center correct it.  
Press button J on the instrument cluster for  
However you choose to set your reference numbers, the  
scheduled services as posted in the Service Booklet  
must be followed to properly care for your vehicle.  
approximately 2 seconds.  
Flexible service system  
111  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
112  
Car care  
Index  
Engine oil level indicator  
Engine oil level indicator  
Turn the electronic key in steering lock to position 2.  
To call up the trip odometer and main odometer, press  
button è or ÿ on the multifunction steering  
wheel until the display appears. See page 92.  
Press button j or k on the multifunction  
steering wheel repeatedly until the “MEASUREMENT  
CORRECT – ONLY IF VEH. LEVEL” engine oil level  
indicator appears. This indicator is only a reminder.  
Measurement can be cancelled by pressing button j  
or k if the vehicle is not parked on level ground. An  
incorrect reading will be recorded if you do not cancel  
the measurement. Move the vehicle to level ground and  
measure again.  
The electronic key in steering lock is not in position 2 if  
the “ENGINE OIL LEVEL – SWITCH ON IGNITION”  
message appears.  
To check the engine oil level, park vehicle on level  
ground, with engine at normal operational temperature.  
The “ENGINE OIL LEVEL – MEASURING NOW”  
message is displayed after approximately 3 seconds.  
Check oil level approximately 5 minutes after stopping  
the engine, allowing for the oil to return to the oil pan.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
One of the following messages will subsequently appear  
on the indicator:  
Perform the engine oil level check with the dipstick, if it  
cannot be completed via the multifunction display.  
See page 256.  
“ENGINE OIL LEVEL – O.K.”  
No oil needs to be added.  
In this case we recommend that you have the system  
checked at a Mercedes-Benz Center.  
“ENGINE OIL LEVEL – ADD 1.0 QUART”  
(Canada: 1.0 L)  
Note:  
“ENGINE OIL LEVEL – ADD 1.5 QUART”  
See malfunction and warning messages on page 234  
and page 244 if an engine oil level indicator appears on  
the multifunction display when the engine is running.  
(Canada: 1.5 L)  
“ENGINE OIL LEVEL – ADD 2.0 QUART”  
(Canada: 2.0 L)  
The engine oil level cannot be checked while the engine  
is running. The “ENGINE OIL LEVEL – NOT WHEN  
ENGINE ON” message will appear.  
See page 256 for instructions on adding engine oil.  
“ENGINE OIL LEVEL – REDUCE OIL LEVEL”  
Do not overfill the engine.  
Excessive oil must be siphoned or drained off. It could  
cause damage to the engine and catalytic converter not  
covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Engine oil consumption  
Engine oil consumption checks should only be made  
after the break-in period. During the break-in period,  
higher oil consumption may be noticed and is normal.  
Frequent driving at high engine speeds results in  
increased consumption.  
The message “PERF. SERV. ON TIME” (perform service  
[engine oil level check] on time) will be displayed if a  
proper oil level check cannot be performed. The engine  
oil level check can be repeated after a short time.  
Engine oil level indicator  
113  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
114  
Car care  
Index  
Exterior lamp switch  
Exterior lamp switch  
B Parking lamps plus low beam or high beam  
headlamps (combination switch pushed forward)  
ˆ Standing lamps, right (turn left one stop)  
Standing lamps, left (turn left two stops)  
Front fog lamps (pull out one stop) with parking  
lamps and/or low beam headlamps on. Green  
indicator lamp in lamp switch comes on.  
Rear fog lamp (pull out to 2nd detent) in addition  
to fog lamps. Yellow indicator lamp in lamp switch  
comes on.  
Standing lamps  
When the vehicle is parked on the street the standing  
lamps (right or left side parking lamps) can be turned  
on, making the vehicle more visible to passing vehicles.  
D Off  
C Parking lamps (also side marker lamps, taillamps,  
license plate lamps, instrument panel lamps)  
Canada only: When the engine is running, the low  
beam is additionally switched on.  
The standing lamps cannot be operated with the  
electronic key in steering lock position 2.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notes:  
Daytime running lamps (Canada only)  
With the electronic key removed and the driver’s door  
open, a warning sounds and the message “SWITCH OFF  
LIGHTS” in the multifunction indicator appears if the  
vehicle’s exterior lamps (except standing lamps) are not  
switched off.  
When the engine is running and the selector lever is in  
a driving position, the low beam headlamps (includes  
parking lamps, side marker lamps, taillamps and  
license plate lamps) are automatically switched on.  
When shifting from a driving position to position “N”  
or “P”, the low beam switches off (2 seconds delay).  
Fog lamps will operate with the parking lamps and/or  
the low beam headlamps on. Fog lamps should only be  
used in conjunction with low beam headlamps. Consult  
your State or Province Motor Vehicle Regulations  
regarding allowable lamp operation.  
For nighttime driving the exterior lamp switch should  
be turned to position B to permit activation of the  
high beam headlamps.  
Fog lamps are automatically switched off when the  
exterior lamp switch is turned to position D.  
Night security illumination  
When exiting the vehicle after driving with the exterior  
lamps on, they switch on again for added illumination  
for approximately 30 seconds after closing the last door.  
The lamp-on time period can be changed at your  
Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Exterior lamp switch  
115  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
116  
Car care  
Index  
Headlamp cleaning system  
Headlamp cleaning system (optional)  
The switch is located in the center console.  
The headlamp washer can be activated with the  
electronic key in steering lock position 2.  
Briefly press symbol side of switch.  
P82.15-2007-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Combination switch  
3 High beam flasher (high beam available  
independent of exterior lamp switch position)  
4 Turn signals, right  
5 Turn signals, left  
4
4
To signal minor directional changes, such as changing  
lanes on a highway, move combination switch to the  
point of resistance only and hold it there.  
2
To operate the turn signals continuously, move the  
combination switch past the point of resistance (up or  
down). The switch is automatically canceled when the  
steering wheel is turned to a large enough degree.  
1
3
5
5
P54.25-2034-26  
Turn signal failure  
1 Low beam (exterior lamp switch position B)  
If one of the turn signals fails, the turn signal indicator  
system flashes and sounds at a faster than normal rate.  
2 High beam (exterior lamp switch position B)  
Combination switch  
117  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
     
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
118  
Car care  
Index  
Combination switch  
7 Windshield wiper  
7
0
I
Wiper off  
Intermittent wiping  
(optional rain sensor: One initial wipe, pauses  
between wipes are automatically controlled by a  
rain sensor monitoring the wetness of the  
windshield.)  
Notes:  
With switch in this position, one wipe occurs  
when turning the electronic main key in steering  
lock from position 0.  
6
P54.25-2033-26  
Optional rain sensor:  
6 Control for windshield wiper/washer system:  
Do not leave in intermittent setting when vehicle  
is taken to an automatic car wash or during  
windshield cleaning. Wiper will operate in  
presence of water spray at windshield, and wiper  
may be damaged as a result.  
Push briefly for single wipe without adding washer  
fluid (use only when windshield is wet).  
Push past detent and hold to activate wiper and  
washer.  
II Normal wiper speed  
III Fast wiper speed  
Notes:  
The windshield washer reservoir, hoses and nozzles are  
automatically heated.  
See page 259 for refilling windshield washer/headlamp  
cleaning system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Windshield wiper smears  
Hazard warning flasher switch  
If the windshield wiper smears the windshield, even  
during rain, activate the washer system as often as  
necessary. The fluid in the washer reservoir should be  
mixed in the correct ratio, see page 259.  
Blocked windshield wiper  
If the windshield wiper becomes blocked (for example,  
due to snow), switch off the wiper.  
For safety reasons before removing ice or snow, remove  
electronic key from steering lock. Remove blockage.  
Activate combination switch again (electronic key in  
steering lock position 1).  
The hazard warning flasher can be activated with the  
switch located in the dashboard.  
To activate hazard warning flasher, press switch once.  
To deactivate, press switch again.  
Note:  
With the hazard warning flasher activated, the  
combination switch in position for either left or right  
turn, and the electronic main key in steering lock  
position 2, only the respective left or right side turn  
signals will operate.  
Hazard warning flasher  
119  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
120  
Car care  
Index  
Automatic climate control  
Automatic climate control  
3
3
4
1
2
5
P83.40-2157-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1 Air volume control for center air outlets, turn wheel  
The temperature selector should be left at the desired  
temperature setting. The temperature selected is  
reached as quickly as possible.  
up to open.  
2 Air volume control for side air outlet.  
To open air outlets: Turn wheel to position i.  
3 Center air outlet, adjustable  
The system will not heat or cool any quicker by setting a  
higher or lower temperature.  
The automatic climate control removes considerable  
moisture from the air during operation in the cooling  
mode. It is normal for water to drip on the ground  
through ducts in the underbody.  
4 Side air outlet, adjustable  
5 Display and controls  
The system is always at operational readiness, except  
when manually switched off.  
The desired interior temperature can be selected  
separately for the left and right side of the passenger  
compartment.  
The automatic climate control only operates with the  
engine running.  
Automatic climate control  
121  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
122  
Car care  
Index  
Automatic climate control  
Display and controls  
P Defrost  
O Air recirculation  
F Rear window defroster  
b Air distribution, manual  
S Economy mode  
ï Air volume, manual  
T Residual engine heat utilization  
0
MAX  
Basic setting - automatic mode  
Press left and right U button for automatic mode.  
Simultaneously press both f and g buttons for  
temperature setting of 72°F.  
Press the desired button to activate, indicator lamp is on  
while activated.  
Q
U Automatic mode  
f Raise temperature  
g Lower temperature  
Air volume and distribution are controlled  
automatically.  
This setting can be used all year around.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Economy  
Defrosting  
Turn wheels (2) to position i to open left and right  
side air outlets (4). Adjust side air outlets upward.  
The function of this setting corresponds to the  
automatic mode. However, because the air conditioning  
compressor will not engage (fuel savings), it is not  
possible to air condition in this setting.  
Press P button. Maximum heated and automatically  
controlled amount of air is directed to the windshield  
and side windows.  
Press S button to activate.  
Press S button once again to return to previous  
setting.  
P
Press P button once again to return to previous  
setting.  
Special settings (use only for short duration)  
Defogging windows  
Switch off O button.  
Press left and right U buttons.  
Press button b repeatedly until air is directed  
upward.  
U
Turn wheels (2) to position i to open left and right  
side air outlets (4). Adjust side air outlets upward.  
Automatic climate control  
123  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
       
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
124  
Car care  
Index  
Automatic climate control  
Rear window defroster  
Air distribution  
Turn electronic key in steering lock to position 2.  
To select, press F button.  
T
requested symbol is displayed.  
Press b button for each side repeatedly until the  
To cancel, press F button again.  
Press U button to return to automatic mode.  
Notes:  
Heavy accumulation of snow and ice should be removed  
before activating the defroster.  
Air volume  
The rear window defroster consumes a large amount of  
electrical power. To keep the battery drain to a  
minimum, turn off the defroster as soon as the window  
is clear.  
Press – or + side of rocker switch ï until the  
requested blower speed is attained. A choice of 7 blower  
speeds is available.  
To switch the automatic climate control off, press – side  
The defroster is automatically turned off after a  
maximum of 12 minutes of operation.  
of rocker switch ï until symbol OFF is displayed.  
If several power consumers are turned on  
I
simultaneously, or the battery is only partially charged,  
it is possible that the defroster will automatically turn  
itself off. When this happens, the indicator lamp inside  
the switch starts blinking.  
The fresh air supply to the vehicle interior is shut off.  
While driving, use this setting only temporarily,  
otherwise the windshield could fog up.  
To switch the automatic climate control on again, press  
U, P or +side of ï.  
As soon as the battery has sufficient voltage, the  
defroster automatically turns itself back on.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Air recirculation  
Residual engine heat utilization  
This mode can be selected to temporarily reduce the  
entry of annoying odors or dust into the vehicle’s  
interior.  
With the engine switched off, it is possible to continue  
heating the interior for a short while.  
Air volume and distribution are controlled  
automatically.  
Outside air is not supplied to the vehicle’s interior.  
To select, press O button.  
To select:  
To cancel, press O button again.  
Turn electronic key in steering lock to position 1 or 0 or  
remove key.  
The system will automatically switch from recirculated  
air to fresh air  
Press T button  
after approx. 5 minutes at outside temperatures  
This function selection will not activate if the battery  
charge level is insufficient.  
below approx. 40°F (5°C),  
after approx. 30 minutes at outside temperatures  
above approx. 40°F (5°C),  
To cancel:  
after approx. 5 minutes, if button S is pressed.  
Press T button.  
If the windows should fog up from the inside, switch  
from recirculated air back to fresh air.  
The system will automatically shut off  
if you turn electronic key in steering lock to  
At high outside temperatures, the system automatically  
engages the recirculated air mode thereby increasing  
the cooling capacity performance, switching to partially  
fresh air within 30 minutes.  
position 2,  
after approx. 30 minutes,  
if the battery voltage drops.  
Automatic climate control  
125  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
126  
Car care  
Index  
Automatic climate control  
Dust filter  
Important!  
Nearly all dust particles and pollen are filtered out  
before outside air enters the passenger compartment  
through the air distribution system.  
This vehicle is equipped with an air conditioner system  
that uses R–134a (HFC: hydrofluorocarbon) as a  
refrigerant. Repairs should always be performed by a  
qualified technician, and refrigerant should be collected  
in a recovery system for recycling.  
Note:  
Keep the air intake grille in front of windshield free of  
snow and debris.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Audio and telephone, operation  
Operating safety  
Warning!  
These instructions are intended to help you become  
acquainted with your Mercedes-Benz vehicle radio.  
They contain useful tips and a detailed description of  
the user functions.  
Any alternations made to electronic components  
can cause malfunctions.  
The radio, cassette deck, CD changer1 and  
telephone1 are interconnected. Therefore, when  
one of the components is defective or has not been  
removed/replaced properly this may impair the  
function of other components.  
Warning!  
In order to avoid distraction which could lead to an  
accident, system settings should be entered with  
the vehicle at standstill and systems should be  
operated by the driver only when traffic conditions  
permit. Always pay full attention to traffic  
conditions first before operating system controls  
while driving.  
These malfunctions might seriously impair the  
operating safety of your vehicle.  
We recommend that you have any service work or  
alternations on electronic components done in an  
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph  
(approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is covering  
a distance of approximately 50 feet (approximately  
14 m) every second.  
1
Optional equipment  
Dolby and the double-D symbol Ù are trademarks of Dolby  
Laboratories Licensing Corporation. The Dolby noise reduction  
system is manufactured under licence from Dolby Laboratories  
Licensing Corporation.  
The right to correct errors and make technical amendments is  
reserved.  
Audio system  
127  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
128  
Car care  
Index  
Audio system  
Operating and display elements  
1 On/off, volume, see page 131  
7 Display panel  
The cassette slot is located behind the display panel.  
For notes on playing cassettes, see page 135.  
2 Telephone mode selector, see page 143  
3 Seek, see page 133, 137 and 141  
4 Radio mode selector, see page 133  
8 Alpha-numeric keypad for  
station storage and frequency entry, see page 134  
CD/Track access, see page 142  
optional telephone, see page 143  
5 Tune, see page 133 and 134  
Fast forward/reverse, see page 137  
9 Function button, see page 134 and 142  
6 CD mode selector, see page 140  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
10 Soft keys for  
radio band selection, see page 133  
tone controls, see page 131  
scan, see page 134  
Tape eject, see page 136  
Tape track select, see page 136  
Dolby, see page 138  
CD Random/repeat, see page 142  
11 Tape mode selector, see page 135  
Anti-theft system  
If the power supply to the  
radio has been interrupted,  
“CODE” will appear on the  
display when it is next  
The code number is shown on the Radio code card,  
supplied with the radio.  
switched on. The radio will  
only work after the five-digit code has been entered  
using the buttons on the right-hand control panel.  
Important!  
Never leave the Radio code card in the vehicle. Keep it in  
a safe place.  
Audio system  
129  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
130  
Car care  
Index  
Audio system  
Entering the code number  
Button and soft key operation  
Switch on the radio. “CODE” will appear on the display.  
Using the buttons on the alpha-numeric keypad, enter  
the five digit code. Confirm by pressing the “OK” key.  
In these instructions, the alpha-numeric keypad (right  
side of radio face) and the function buttons (left side of  
the radio face) are referred to as “buttons” and the four  
keys under the display are referred to as “soft keys”.  
If an incorrect code has been entered and confirmed,  
“CODE” will reappear on the display. The correct code  
must be entered once again.  
Note:  
Do not press directly on the radio display face.  
If an incorrect code is entered  
three times, “WAIT” will  
appear on the display and the  
radio will be locked out for  
about 10 minutes.  
Note:  
The lock out time will only count down if the radio is left  
switched on.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operation  
Audio functions  
The AUD key is used to select the BASS, TREBLE and  
BALANCE functions. Settings for bass and treble are  
stored separately for the cassette and CD modes. Tone  
level settings are identified by the vertical bars. The  
center (flat) setting is shown by one longer bar in the  
center of the display.  
Switching on and off  
Press the control knob  
.
The radio is switched off when the ignition key is turned  
to position 0 or removed from the ignition. The radio is  
switched on again when the ignition key is turned to  
position 1 or 2.  
Bass  
Note:  
Press the AUD key repeatedly  
until “BASS” appears in the  
display.  
The radio can also be switched on even if the ignition  
key is not inserted, but will switch itself off  
automatically after one hour to conserve vehicle battery  
power.  
Treble  
Adjusting the volume  
Press the AUD key repeatedly  
until “TREBLE” appears in the  
display.  
Turn the control knob - turning the knob clockwise will  
increase the volume, counterclockwise will decrease the  
volume.  
Press the “+” key to increase  
or the “-” key to decrease the level.  
Audio system  
131  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
     
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
132  
Car care  
Index  
Audio system  
Fader1  
Centering all audio functions  
Press the AUD key repeatedly  
until “FADER” appears on the  
display. Press the “R” key to  
move the sound to the rear  
speakers or the “F” key to  
Push and hold down the  
“AUD” key. All audio  
functions (bass, treble,  
balance and fader) are set to  
center or flat positions, and  
move the sound to the front speakers.  
the volume is adjusted to a pre-set level.  
Balance  
Press the AUD key repeatedly  
until “BALANCE” appears in  
the display.  
Press the “L” key to move the  
sound to the left speaker or the “R” key to move the  
sound to the right speaker.  
1
not available on all models  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Radio mode  
Manual tuning  
Press either the  
or  
Selecting radio mode  
button. Step-by-step tuning in  
ascending or descending  
order of frequency will take  
place.  
Press  
button.  
Selecting the band  
The first three tuning steps will take place without  
muting. The radio will then be muted and high-speed  
tuning will take place until the button is released.  
The following tuning intervals will be shown on the  
display:  
Press the key located below  
the desired band. The band  
selected is shown in the top  
line of the display.  
FM  
AM  
WB  
200 kHz  
10 kHz  
Channels 1-7  
Frequency ranges:  
FM  
87.9 - 107.9 MHz  
530 - 1710 kHz  
approx. 162 MHz  
AM  
WB  
Seek tuning  
Press either the  
or  
button. The radio will tune  
to the next receivable station.  
Audio system  
133  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
           
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
134  
Car care  
Index  
Audio system  
Scan tuning  
Storing stations  
Press the SC key. Each strong  
receivable station on the band  
selected will be tuned in for  
8 seconds. The first scan will  
tune only the stations with a  
Hold the number button down for approximately  
2 seconds. The currently displayed frequency is stored  
on the selected station button. The storage procedure is  
confirmed by a short signal tone.  
high signal strength. The second scan will tune every  
receivable station. By pressing either the  
or buttons, or the “SC” key the scan mode  
Retrieving a station from memory  
,
,
Press the desired station button.  
can be cancelled.  
Direct frequency input (AM and FM only)  
Station memory  
Select the band. Press the  
button and enter the  
desired frequency using the  
alpha-numeric keypad.  
Frequencies outside of the  
Ten stations can be stored in  
the AM and FM bands via the  
alpha-numeric keypad. The  
“0” button corresponds to  
location 10. Weatherband  
frequency ranges (frequencies specified on page 133)  
will not be accepted. The frequency input mode is  
cancelled if no button is pressed within 4 seconds.  
(WB) channels 1 to 7 can be retrieved via the alpha-  
numeric keypad and are preset at the factory.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Cassette mode  
Note:  
Do not press directly on the radio display face.  
Note:  
Return the display panel to its normal position by  
folding it back up and pressing gently on the display  
frame to lock in place.  
Vehicles equipped with the COMAND system do not  
come with a factory installed cassette mechanism.  
A standard 1/8” stereo phono plug for auxiliary audio  
input (located in glove box) is provided for connection of  
a portable battery operated cassette player or any other  
portable device which uses a headphone output. Please  
refer to the COMAND operating manual for information  
concerning the activation of the audio input.  
When playing mono recorded tapes (e.g. books) through  
a stereo system the sound from one track might bleed to  
the other track, despite setting the balance to the full  
left or full right speakers.  
Important!  
If the display is in the down position for more than  
20 seconds, 2 successive beeps will be heard. This will  
continue at 5 second intervals until the display is  
returned to its normal position.  
Playing cassettes  
Press the “TAPE” button. When the eject (EJ) key is  
pressed, the display folds down and the cassette slot  
becomes visible. Push the cassette into the slot until it  
engages. The cassette will be pulled in automatically.  
Audio system  
135  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
136  
Car care  
Index  
Audio system  
The radio will switch to  
Cassette eject  
cassette mode. Track 1 will be  
played and “SIDE 1”  
displayed. Track 1 is the side  
of the cassette which is facing  
Press the eject (EJ) key. The display will fold down and  
the cassette will be ejected. Remove the cassette, then  
fold the display back up manually. The radio will switch  
back to radio mode automatically.  
upwards. The cassette deck will automatically detect the  
type of tape and switch the equalization automatically.  
A cassette symbol in the display indicates that a tape is  
in the mechanism. This symbol appears in all modes but  
not in cassette mode.  
Note:  
The cassette will not be ejected when the radio is  
switched off.  
The cassette will not be ejected when the radio is  
switched off or another mode is selected.  
Important!  
If the display is in the down position for more than  
20 seconds, 2 successive beeps will be heard. This will  
continue at 5 second intervals until the display is  
returned to its normal position.  
If a cassette is in the  
mechanism, cassette mode  
can be selected by using the  
“TAPE” button. If no cassette  
has been inserted, the display  
will show “NO TAPE”.  
Track selection  
Press the track selection  
(TRK) key. The current track  
will be displayed as “SIDE 1”  
or “SIDE 2”. The track will be  
changed automatically at the  
end of the tape.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Track search forwards/backwards  
Fast forward/reverse  
Press the  
button.  
Press the  
button.  
“SEEK FWD” will be shown on  
the display and the track  
search will run the tape  
forwards to the start of the  
next track.  
“FORWARD” will appear on  
the display and fast forward  
will start.  
Press the  
button.  
“REWIND” will appear on the  
display and fast reverse will  
start.  
Press the  
“SEEK RWD” will be shown  
button.  
on the display and the track  
search will run the tape  
backwards to the start of the  
Fast forward/reverse is stopped by pressing the same  
button again, or it will stop automatically at the  
beginning or the end of the tape. The track will  
automatically change at the end or beginning of the tape  
and play will begin.  
track currently playing. Track search can be interrupted  
by pressing the same button again.  
Note:  
The beginning of a track can only be located if there is a  
break of at least 4 seconds between tracks.  
Audio system  
137  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
138  
Car care  
Index  
Audio system  
Scanning  
Dolby NR1 (noise reduction system)  
Press the “SC” key. Each track  
on the cassette will be played  
for 8 seconds in ascending  
order.  
To enable optimum  
reproduction of cassettes  
recorded using the Dolby B  
system, press the “AUD” key  
followed by the NR key so the  
Note:  
“NR” in the display is not highlighted. To turn off  
Dolby B noise reduction, press the “NR” key so the “NR”  
in the display is highlighted.  
The beginning of a track can only be located if there is a  
break of at least 4 seconds between tracks.  
1
Dolby and the double-D symbol Ù are trademarks of Dolby  
Laboratories Licensing Corporation. The Dolby noise reduction  
system is manufactured under licence from Dolby Laboratories  
Licensing Corporation.  
Scan will be interrupted if the  
buttons or the “SC” key is pressed.  
,
,
,
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CD mode  
Replace the CD in its container after use. Protect CDs  
from heat and direct sunlight.  
General notes on CD mode  
Warning!  
Should excessive temperatures occur while in CD mode,  
“TEMP HIGH” will appear in the display and muting  
will take place. The unit will then switch back to radio  
mode until the temperature has decreased to a safe  
operating level.  
The CD changer1 is a Class 1 laser product. There is  
a danger of invisible laser radiation if the cover is  
opened or damaged.  
Do not remove the cover. The CD changer1 does not  
contain any parts which can be serviced by the  
user. For safety reasons, have any service work  
which may be necessary performed only by  
qualified personnel.  
Should temperatures occur while in CD mode which are  
too low, “TEMP LOW” will be displayed, but the CD will  
play. It will be sensitive to skipping if you are driving  
over rough roads.  
1
Optional equipment  
Handle CDs carefully to prevent interference during  
playback.  
Avoid fingerprints and dust on CDs. Do not write on the  
CDs or apply any label to the CDs.  
Clean CDs from time to time with a commercially  
available cleaning cloth. No solvents, anti-static sprays,  
etc. should be used.  
Audio system  
139  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
140  
Car care  
Index  
Audio system  
CD changer installed  
Loading/emptying the CD magazine  
Slide the changer door to the right and press the eject  
button . The magazine will be ejected. Remove the  
magazine. Pull out the CD tray until its stop is reached  
and place the CDs in the recess of the tray, label side up.  
Push the tray into the magazine in the direction shown  
by the arrow. Insert the loaded magazine into the  
changer.  
4
2
3
1
Important!  
Close the door after the magazine has been inserted.  
2
Playing CDs  
Press the “CD” button. The CD most recently played will  
start at the point where it was last switched off. CDs  
stored in the magazine can be selected by using the  
station preset buttons 1-6.  
1 CD changer1  
2 CD magazine  
3 CD tray  
The magazine slot number of  
the selected CD will then be  
displayed after “CD”. The  
number of the track being  
played will be displayed after  
“TRACK”.  
4 CD  
If a CD changer1 is installed, it can be operated from the  
front control panel of the radio. A loaded magazine must  
be installed for CD playing.  
1
Optional equipment  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
If there is no CD in the  
selected magazine slot,  
“NO CD” and the  
corresponding slot number  
will be displayed  
Fast forward/reverse  
Press the  
forward.  
button and hold it down for audible fast  
Press the  
reverse.  
button and hold it down for audible  
(e.g.“NO CD3”). After the last track on a CD has been  
played, the next CD will automatically be selected and  
played.  
The search will stop when the  
button is released. The  
relative time of the track will  
be displayed during the  
search. The search mode will  
cancel if the beginning or end of the CD is reached.  
Skipping tracks forwards/backwards  
Press the  
played.  
button. The next track on the CD will be  
Press the  
button. If the track has been playing for  
Scanning  
more than 10 seconds, it will revert to the start of that  
track. If it has been playing for less than ten seconds it  
will revert to the preceding track. To skip several tracks,  
the respective button must be pressed until the desired  
track is reached. If the beginning or end of the CD is  
reached during the search, the first or last track will be  
played.  
Press the SC key. Each track will be played for 8 seconds  
in ascending order. The search will stop at the track in  
question if the  
,
,
,
buttons or the  
“SC” key is pressed.  
Audio system  
141  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
142  
Car care  
Index  
Audio system  
Random play/repeat function  
Direct track selection  
The tracks of the current CD are played in random order  
when the random feature (RDM) is selected. Press the  
RDM key to switch on, and press RDM again to switch  
off.  
Tracks can be selected directly using the buttons on the  
alpha-numeric keypad. Press the function button,  
followed by the track number.  
When the repeat function  
(RPT) has been selected, a  
particular track can be played  
for as many times as desired.  
Press the RPT key to switch  
on, and press RPT again to switch off.  
Note:  
Both functions cannot be used simultaneously.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Telephone operation  
Entering telephone number and starting dialing  
process  
Various functions of the Mercedes-Benz integrated  
cellular telephone1 can be performed and displayed via  
the car radio. Further instructions for operating the car  
telephone can be found in the operation guide for the  
cellular telephone1.  
Enter the desired telephone  
number using the alpha-  
numeric keypad. The number  
can have up to 32 digits, but  
only 13 of these can be  
displayed. The dialing process is started by pressing the  
SND button. The entered number can be corrected using  
the “CLR” key.  
Switching the telephone on and off  
Switching on: Press the  
button, “TEL” appears in the  
corner of the display.  
Press the CLR key briefly -  
and the last digit will be  
deleted.  
Switching off: Press and hold  
button until the telephone symbol “TEL” no  
the  
Press the CLR key longer - and  
the complete number will be deleted.  
longer appears in the display, or press the “PWR” button  
on the phone’s keypad.  
1
Optional equipment  
Calling up the phone book  
The numbers stored in the telephone memory can be  
called up via either name or number entries. The  
memory contents from the portable phone must be  
downloaded and the telephone menu must be selected  
in order to call up the phone book. Refer to the  
“Memory download” section of the cellular telephone  
operation guide for more information.  
Audio system  
143  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
     
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
144  
Car care  
Index  
Audio system  
Switching between name search and number search  
Press ABC key - Name search  
Placing a call  
When a number or a name  
has been selected using the  
method described above,  
press the SND key.  
Press NUM key - Number search  
Searching and selecting phone book entries by name  
Press the ABC key. The current name is shown on the  
display. The stored entries in alphabetical order can be  
Manual repeat dialing (redial)  
The last number entered can be re-selected by pressing  
the SND key once and the call can be placed by pressing  
the SND key a second time. The last dialed telephone  
number is shown on the display. Using the  
or button, the numbers stored in the re-dial  
memory of the telephone can be selected.  
selected using the  
or  
button. By pressing the  
or buttons, the stored entries can be selected  
according to alphabetical initial letters (e.g. A-Adam,  
B-Brown, M-Miller).  
,
,
Searching and selecting phone book entries by  
number  
The abbreviation L and the  
number in the memory are  
shown in the top line of the  
display.  
Press the NUM key. The current number is shown on  
the display. The stored entries can be selected in  
numerical order using the  
pressing the or  
or  
button. By  
buttons, the stored entries  
can be selected in increments of 5 (e.g. Entry no. 2,  
Entry no. 7, etc.).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accepting incoming call in telephone mode  
Component malfunctions  
With an incoming call, the ringing tone will be heard  
and the message “CALL” appears in the display. Press  
the SND key to answer the call.  
The radio, CD changer1, and Mercedes-Benz integrated  
cellular telephone1 are part of a fiberoptic networked  
system. Failure of one of the components can lead to  
malfunctions of the other components. Please contact  
your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or call  
1-800-FOR-MERCedes formore informationinthe event  
of a malfunction.  
Accepting incoming call in tape, CD or radio mode  
If the telephone is activated in the background  
(telephone symbol in the display), then a switch is made  
automatically to telephone when an incoming call is  
received. The audio source is muted, the ringing tone is  
heard and the message “CALL” appears. After the call  
has been terminated, the previously selected audio  
source is resumed.  
1
Optional equipment  
Terminating call  
A current call can be terminated by pressing the END  
key.  
Audio system  
145  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
146  
Car care  
Index  
Interior equipment  
Power windows  
Turn electronic key in steering lock to position 1 or 2.  
Press switch in to resistance point:  
k to open  
j to close  
Release switch when window is in desired position.  
Warning!  
When closing the windows, be sure that there is no  
danger of anyone being harmed by the closing  
procedure.  
The closing procedure can be immediately reversed  
by either pressing the switch k or pressing  
button Œ on the remote control, and holding it.  
Power window switches are located on center console.  
When leaving the vehicle, always remove the  
electronic key from the steering lock, and lock the  
vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the  
vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.  
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment can cause  
serious personal injury.  
1 left, front  
2 left, rear  
3 right, front  
4 right, rear  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Express opening and closing of door windows  
Note:  
Press switch k or j past resistance point and  
release — window opens or closes completely.  
The power windows can also be opened and closed with  
the infrared remote control while locking the vehicle  
doors or trunk, see page 32.  
To interrupt procedure, briefly press k or j.  
If the upward movement of the window is blocked  
during the closing procedure, the window will stop  
during the last few inches before closure and open  
slightly.  
Synchronizing power windows  
If the power supply was interrupted (battery  
disconnected or low), the windows cannot be opened by  
the Express feature.  
When pressing and holding the switch j to close the  
window, and upward movement of the window is  
blocked during the last few inches before closure, it will  
stop but not open slightly.  
To resynchronize the express feature, press j side of  
power window switch until the window is completely  
closed and hold for additional 2 seconds. Repeat  
procedure for each window.  
Warning!  
The automatic full opening procedure of the windows  
should now be restored.  
When leaving the vehicle, always remove the  
electronic key from the steering lock and lock the  
vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the  
vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.  
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment can cause  
serious personal injury.  
Interior equipment  
147  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
148  
Car care  
Index  
Interior equipment  
Power windows – operated with soft top switch  
When leaving the vehicle, always remove the  
electronic key from the steering lock, and lock the  
vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the  
vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.  
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment can cause  
serious personal injury.  
The soft top handle must be in the locked position to  
operate the power windows.  
Turn electronic key in steering lock to position 1 or 2.  
To open:  
Lift soft top switch quickly twice and hold.  
To close:  
Soft top switch is located on center console.  
Press soft top switch quickly twice and hold.  
Release switch when windows are in desired position.  
In addition to the power window switches, the windows  
can also be opened or closed with the soft top switch.  
Warning!  
When closing the windows, be sure that there is no  
danger of anyone being harmed by the closing  
procedure.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Interior lighting  
1 Automatic interior lighting  
Press once and the automatic interior lighting is  
activated.  
2
Interior lamps are switched on, and off (soft fade)  
delayed, when unlocking or locking the vehicle, or  
when opening or closing a door. However, there will  
be no (soft fade) delay when the electronic key is in  
steering lock position 2.  
3
4
1
Press again and interior lamps remain switched off,  
even when centrally unlocking or opening a door.  
2 Press to switch interior and reading lamps on or off.  
3 Press to switch reading lamp on or off.  
P68.00-2297-26  
4 Press to switch reading lamp on or off.  
Entrance lamps, exit lamps in doors  
The lamps are switched on and off by the door contact  
switches.  
Note:  
To prevent the vehicle battery from being discharged,  
with doors open all interior lamps go out after  
approximately 5 minutes.  
Interior equipment  
149  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
150  
Car care  
Index  
Interior equipment  
Sun visors  
Illuminated vanity mirrors  
Swing sun visors down to protect against sun glare.  
With the visor engaged in its inner mounting, the lamp  
is switched on by opening the cover.  
If sunlight enters through a side window, disengage  
visor from inner mounting, pivot it to the side, and slide  
it to the desired position.  
Warning!  
Do not use the vanity mirror while driving.  
The lamp goes out automatically after approximately  
5 minutes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Interior  
Glove box  
Warning!  
To help avoid personal injury during a collision or  
sudden maneuver, exercise care when stowing  
things. Put luggage or cargo in the trunk if  
possible. Do not pile luggage or cargo higher than  
the seat backs. Do not place anything on the shelf  
below the rear window.  
1
2
3
Luggage nets cannot secure hard or heavy objects.  
Storage compartments, armrest and cup holder  
Warning!  
P68.00-2067-26  
Keep compartment lids closed. This will help to  
prevent stored objects from being thrown about  
and injuring vehicle occupants during an accident  
and sudden maneuvers.  
1 Unlocking: Turn mechanical key to vertical position  
and remove.  
2 Locking: Turn mechanical key to the right and  
remove.  
3 Opening: Pull on handle.  
The glove box can be locked and unlocked with the  
mechanical key. See page 25 for instructions on how to  
remove the mechanical key from the electronic main  
key (e.g. for valet parking service).  
Interior equipment  
151  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
       
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
152  
Car care  
Index  
Interior equipment  
Storage compartments in center console  
To open compartment in armrest:  
Press button (4) and lift lid.  
To open compartment under armrest:  
Press button (5) and lift lid.  
To close:  
Lower lid until it engages in lock.  
To open cover:  
Touch top of cover (6) slightly. The cover opens  
automatically.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cup holder in center console  
Notes:  
The right claw is adjustable to accommodate most  
container sizes.  
An additional second (smaller size) container can be  
placed in the cup holder.  
Spilling liquids (e.g. soda or coffee) could restrict the  
movement of the claw. Refer to page 306 for cleaning  
the cup holder.  
Caution!  
Keep cup holder closed while traveling. Place only  
containers that fit into the cup holder to prevent spills.  
Do not fill containers to a height where the contents  
could spill during vehicle maneuvers, especially hot  
liquids.  
To open cup holder:  
Briefly press button (7). The cup holder opens  
automatically.  
To store cup holder:  
Push button (7) down until cup holder engages. Close  
cover (6).  
Interior equipment  
153  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
154  
Car care  
Index  
Interior equipment  
Ashtray  
Prior to removing the ashtray insert, move the gear  
selector lever to position “N”.  
Warning!  
Remove front ashtray only with vehicle standing  
still. With the gear selector lever in position “N”,  
turn off the engine and set the parking brake.  
Otherwise the vehicle might move as a result of  
unintended contact with the gear selector lever.  
To remove ashtray:  
Push sliding knob (1) toward the right to eject the  
insert.  
To install ashtray:  
Center console, front  
Install insert into ashtray frame and push down to  
engage.  
By touching the bottom of the cover lightly, the ashtray  
opens automatically.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Lighter  
Turn electronic key in steering lock to position 1 or 2.  
Push in lighter (1); it will pop out automatically when  
hot.  
Warning!  
Never touch the heating element or sides of the  
lighter, they are extremely hot, hold at knob only.  
When leaving the vehicle always remove the  
electronic key from the steering lock. Do not leave  
children unattended in the vehicle, or with access  
to an unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use of vehicle  
equipment may cause serious personal injury.  
The lighter socket can be used to accommodate  
electrical accessories up to maximum 85 W.  
Interior equipment  
Instruments  
155  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
and controls  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
156  
Car care  
Index  
Interior equipment  
Cargo tie down rings  
Parcel net in front passenger footwell  
A small convenience parcel net is located in the front  
passenger footwell. It is for small and light items, such  
as road maps, mail, etc..  
Warning!  
Do not place heavy or fragile objects, or objects  
having sharp edges, in the parcel net.  
In an accident, during hard braking or sudden  
maneuvers, they could be thrown around inside  
the vehicle, and cause injury to vehicle occupants.  
Note:  
With large objects stored in the parcel net do not slide  
the seat fully forward, it could damage them.  
1 Ring  
Carefully secure cargo by applying even load on all four  
rings with rope of sufficient strength to hold down the  
cargo.  
Armrest, rear bench  
Pull down the armrest by its top.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Telephone, general  
Warning!  
Note:  
See separate instruction manual for instructions on how  
to operate the telephone.  
A driver’s attention to the road must always be his/  
her primary focus when driving. For your safety  
and the safety of others, we recommend that you  
pull over to a safe location and stop before placing  
or taking a telephone call. If you choose to use the  
telephone while driving, please use the hands-free  
device and only use the telephone when road and  
traffic conditions permit.  
Cellular telephone  
The vehicle is prepared for the installation of a cellular  
telephone. For further information and installation  
contact your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Warning!  
Some jurisdictions prohibit the driver from using a  
cellular telephone while driving a vehicle.  
Some jurisdictions prohibit the driver from using a  
cellular telephone while driving a vehicle. Whether  
or not prohibited by law, for safety reasons, the  
driver should not use the cellular telephone while  
the vehicle is in motion. Stop the vehicle in a safe  
location before answering or placing a call.  
Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph  
(approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is covering  
a distance of approximately 50 feet (approximately  
14 m) every second.  
Never operate radio transmitters equipped with a  
built-in or attached antenna (i.e. without being  
connected to an external antenna) from inside the  
vehicle while the engine is running. Doing so could  
lead to a malfunction of the vehicle’s electronic  
system, possibly resulting in an accident and  
personal injury.  
Telephone  
157  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
158  
Car care  
Index  
Garage door opener  
Garage door opener  
The built-in remote control is capable of operating up to  
three separately controlled objects.  
Warning!  
When programming a garage door opener, the door  
moves up or down.  
When programming or operating the remote  
control make sure there is no possibility of anyone  
being harmed by the moving door.  
2
1
Notes:  
Certain types of garage door openers are incompatible  
with the integrated opener. If you should experience  
difficulties with programming the transmitter, contact  
your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center, or call  
Mercedes-Benz Client Assistance Center (in the USA  
only) at 1-800-FOR-MERCedes, or Customer Service (in  
Canada) at 1-800-387-0100.  
3
1 Signal transmitter keys  
2 Indicator lamp  
3 Portable remote control transmitter  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
For operation in the USA only: This device complies  
with Part 15, Subpart C, Section 209 of the FCC Rules.  
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
3. Using both hands, simultaneously push the hand-  
held transmitter button and the desired integrated  
remote control button. Do not release the buttons  
until completing step 4.  
(1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and  
4. The indicator lamp on the integrated remote control  
will flash, first slowly and then rapidly. When the  
indicator lamp flashes rapidly, both buttons may be  
released (the rapid flashing lamp indicates  
successful programming of the new frequency  
signal). To program the remaining two buttons,  
follow steps 1 though 4.  
(2) this device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired  
operation.  
WARNING: Changes or modification not expressly  
approved by party responsible for compliance could void  
the user’s authority to operate the equipment.  
Programming or reprogramming the integrated  
remote control:  
Note:  
If after repeated attempts, you do not successfully  
program the integrated remote control device to learn  
the signal of the hand-held transmitter, the garage door  
opener could be equipped with the “rolling code  
feature”.  
1. Turn electronic key in steering lock to position 1  
or 2.  
2. Hold the end of the hand-held transmitter of the  
device you wish to train approximately 2 to 5 inches  
(5 cm to 12 cm) away from the surface of the  
integrated remote control located on the inside rear  
view mirror, keeping the indicator lamp in view.  
Garage door opener  
159  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
160  
Car care  
Index  
Garage door opener  
Rolling code programming:  
3. Firmly press and release the programmed  
integrated remote control transmit button. Press  
and release same button a second time to complete  
the training process. (Some garage door openers  
may requires you to do this procedure a third time  
to complete the training.)  
To train a garage door opener (or other rolling code  
devices) with the rolling code feature, follow these  
instructions after completing the “Programming”  
portion of this text. (A second person may make the  
following training procedures quicker and easier.)  
4. Confirm the garage door operation by pressing the  
programmed button on the integrated remote  
control transmitter.  
1. Locate training button on the garage door opener  
motor head unit. Exact location and color of the  
button may vary by garage door opener brand. If  
there is difficulty locating the transmitting button,  
reference to garage door opener operator’s manual.  
Canadian programming:  
During programming, your hand-held transmitter may  
automatically stop transmitting. Continue to press and  
hold the integrated remote control transmitter button  
(note steps 2 through 4 in the “Programming” portion)  
while you press and re-press (“cycle”) your hand-held  
transmitter every two seconds until the frequency  
signal has been learned. The indicator lamp will flash  
slowly and then rapidly after several seconds upon  
successful training.  
2. Press “training” button on the garage door opener  
motor head unit (which activated the “training  
light”).  
Note:  
Following step 2, there are 30 seconds to initiate  
step 3.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operation of remote control:  
Erasing the remote control memory:  
1. Turn electronic key in steering lock to position 1  
or 2.  
1. Turn electronic key in steering lock to position 1  
or 2.  
2. Select and press the appropriate button to activate  
the remote controlled device. The integrated remote  
control transmitter continues to send the signal as  
long as the button is pressed – up to 20 seconds.  
2. Simultaneously holding down the left and right side  
buttons for approximately 20 seconds, or until the  
control lamp blinks rapidly, will erase the codes of  
all three channels.  
Garage door opener  
161  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
162  
Car care  
Index  
Soft top  
Soft top  
do not operate the luggage cover with the soft top  
lowered. Doing so will result in damage to the  
luggage cover or the soft top.  
A minimum height clearance of 6 1/2 ft. (2 m) is  
required to lower or raise the soft top.  
Lowering a wet soft top can result in water reaching the  
vehicle interior. The soft top should be dry when  
lowering it into the soft top storage compartment.  
The raising or lowering procedure can only be started  
with the luggage cover and trunk lid closed.  
The raising or lowering procedure is immediately  
interrupted by releasing the soft top switch.  
Do not lower a frozen soft top until thawed and dry.  
Doing so may result in damage not covered by the  
Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Do not operate the soft top while a trunk luggage carrier  
is installed.  
To prevent mildew, the soft top must be dry before  
lowering it into the storage compartment.  
To prevent damage to the soft top, soft top compartment  
cover, trunk lid or luggage/cargo when lowering the  
roof:  
The soft top should not be lowered or raised at outside  
temperatures below +5°F (-15°C), since the material  
becomes less pliable with lower temperatures.  
load trunk only to the height of the luggage cover,  
do not permit luggage/cargo to raise the closed  
Notes:  
luggage cover,  
Rear passengers should lean forward while raising or  
lowering the soft top, to clear the path of the rear  
window.  
do not load anything on top of the luggage cover,  
do not place anything on the soft top compartment  
cover,  
To prevent the soft top from being lowered  
unintentionally while a trunk luggage carrier is  
installed, keep luggage cover in trunk in the open  
position with the soft top raised.  
do not open the trunk lid while the soft top is being  
raised or lowered. This is required since the soft top  
compartment cover moves upward and backward  
during raising or lowering operations,  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Warning!  
Never lock or unlock the soft top while driving.  
Doing so could cause the driver to lose control of  
the vehicle.  
2
1
Driving with an unlocked soft top may cause  
personal injury to you or your passenger, or  
personal injury or property damage to others.  
1
Before operating the soft top switch make sure that  
no persons due to inattention are injured by the  
moving parts (roll bar, soft top frame and soft top  
compartment cover).  
P65.10-2081-26  
Hands must never be placed near the roll bar, soft  
top frame, upper windshield area or soft top storage  
compartment while the soft top is being raised or  
lowered. Serious personal injury may occur.  
Important!  
Do not manually move corner flaps (1) of soft top  
compartment cover. Doing so will result in damage to  
the soft top folding mechanism that is not covered by  
the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
In case of danger release the switch to immediately  
interrupt the operating procedure.  
With the soft top lowered do not place anything on the  
soft top compartment cover (2).  
The soft top compartment cover must never be used by  
any persons as a seat bench. Raising of the roll bar  
could result in personal injury.  
Soft top  
163  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
164  
Car care  
Index  
Soft top  
2
1
P77.30-2080-26  
P77.30-2070-26  
Lowering Soft Top  
Important!  
Push soft top frame approx. 8 inches (20 cm) upward by  
the locking handle. Failing to do so will result in  
damage to the soft top folding mechanism that is not  
covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
1. Engage parking brake.  
2. Close luggage cover and trunk lid.  
For notes on the luggage cover, see page 250.  
3. Turn electronic key in steering lock to position 2.  
Turn locking handle counterclockwise to the stop and  
fold up until it locks in place.  
4. Press lock button (1) and fold down locking  
handle (2).  
The indicator lamp in the soft top switch lights up.  
5. Turn locking handle 90° clockwise to unlock the soft  
The side windows lower.  
top.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6. Lift symbol side of the soft top switch and hold:  
The roll bar lowers (when in the upper position).  
The soft top compartment cover and rear  
window section of the soft top unlocks.  
The rear window section of the soft top raises.  
The soft top compartment cover opens.  
The soft top lowers into its storage compartment.  
The soft top compartment cover closes and  
locks.  
The indicator lamp in the soft top switch goes  
out – the lowering procedure is completed – a  
signal sounds.  
Notes:  
If indicator lamp blinks slowly, a malfunction has  
occurred in the system.  
If the soft top switch is held or is released and lifted  
again within approximately 2 seconds, the side  
windows will close. If the roll bar was previously in the  
upper position, it will return to that position.  
If indicator lamp blinks rapidly, the trunk lid and/or  
the luggage cover may be open, and need to be  
closed.  
The side windows can also be opened/closed later on.  
Lift/press soft top switch twice and hold, see page 148.  
However, the side windows and the roll bar can also be  
activated using their respective switches, see page 146  
and page 53.  
Soft top  
165  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
166  
Car care  
Index  
Soft top  
4. Press symbol side of soft top switch and hold:  
Warning!  
The indicator lamp in the soft top switch lights  
To prevent possible accidents, drive the vehicle  
only with the soft top either completely closed and  
locked, or fully lowered into its storage  
compartment.  
up.  
Notes:  
If indicator lamp blinks slowly, a malfunction  
has occurred in the system.  
Note:  
If indicator lamp blinks rapidly, the trunk lid  
and/or the luggage cover may be open, and need  
to be closed.  
For safety reasons, the soft top cannot be lowered while  
driving.  
The side windows lower.  
Raising Soft Top  
The roll bar lowers (when in the upper position).  
1. Engage parking brake.  
The soft top compartment cover unlocks and  
2. Close luggage cover and trunk lid.  
For notes on the luggage cover, see page 250.  
3. Turn electronic key in steering lock to position 2.  
opens.  
The soft top is raised from its storage  
compartment to the closing position.  
The soft top storage compartment closes and the  
rear window section of the soft top lowers – a  
signal sounds.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2
1
P77.30-2070-26  
5. Press lock button (1) and fold down locking  
handle (2).  
If the soft top switch is held or is released and pressed  
again within approximately 2 seconds, the side  
windows will close. If the roll bar was previously in the  
upright position, it will return to that position.  
6. Turn locking handle 90° clockwise and pull soft top  
frame carefully down until it meets the windshield  
header attachment points.  
The side windows can also be closed/opened later on.  
Press/lift soft top switch twice and hold, see page 148.  
Turn locking handle counterclockwise to the stop to  
lock the soft top.  
However, the side windows and the roll bar can also be  
activated using their respective switches, see page 146  
and page 53.  
Fold locking handle up until it locks in place.  
The indicator lamp in the soft top switch goes out –  
the lowering procedure is completed.  
Soft top  
167  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
168  
Car care  
Index  
Soft top  
Note:  
Stop the vehicle and before continuing to drive,  
close and lock the soft top.  
For safety reasons, the soft top cannot be raised while  
driving.  
If the soft top is not locked, it may fold back or  
forward when driving.  
Warning!  
During soft top operation, do not place your hands  
near the roll bar, soft top frame, upper windshield  
area or soft top storage compartment. Serious  
personal injury may occur.  
The soft top is not fully closed and locked:  
• if the indicator lamp in the soft top switch does  
not got out (electronic key in steering lock  
position 2).  
To prevent possible accidents, drive the vehicle  
only with the soft top either completely closed and  
locked, or fully lowered into its storage  
compartment.  
• if the indicator lamp blinks, and a signal  
sounds for 10 seconds when starting to drive.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the indicator lamp in the soft top switch blinks slowly  
while activating the switch,  
Have the system checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
the battery voltage may be insufficient – start  
Notes:  
engine and let it run while activating switch,  
If the roll bar was raised automatically, the process of  
raising or lowering the soft top will take somewhat  
longer, as the roll bar must first be lowered.  
the system may be overheated (for example after  
lowering or raising the soft top approx. 5  
consecutive times) – after approx. 10 minutes the  
soft top switch may be activated again.  
Whenever possible, park vehicle in the shade as  
continuous exposure to sun rays can prematurely  
deteriorate the soft top material.  
If indicator lamp in the soft top switch blinks rapidly  
while activating the switch,  
The soft top may become moldy and receive permanent  
creases if it is kept in the storage compartment for an  
extended period.  
the trunk lid and/or the luggage cover may be open,  
and need to be closed,  
the soft top is still locked during the opening  
Therefore, we recommend raising and airing it  
thoroughly with the side windows open (do not expose  
it to the sun) at regular intervals during the wet and  
cold seasons.  
procedure and needs to be unlocked,  
the opening/closing procedure is interrupted.  
In this case the soft top needs to be synchronized.  
Turn electronic key in steering lock back to  
position 0, and then to position 2. Activate soft top  
switch again. The soft top should now be operational  
again.  
To prevent damage, the soft top must be dry and clean  
before lowering it into the storage compartment. There  
is the possibility of sharp-edged dirt particles damaging  
the soft top or scratching the rear window.  
If the indicator lamp continues to blink, raise the soft  
top manually, see page 291.  
Soft top  
169  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
170  
Car care  
Index  
Wind screen  
Wind screen (optional)  
Installation  
1. Remove wind screen from its storage bag, located in  
the trunk, secured with hook and loop fasteners,  
and unfold.  
2
2. Pull folded end sections in direction of arrow (1) and  
unfold in direction of arrow (2).  
1
P65.00-2016-26  
The wind screen is most effective when all four side  
windows are fully raised.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3. Insert end section in right opening (3) on quarter  
panel first. Then push left end section toward  
vehicle center (arrow 4) until it meets the left  
opening. Insert end section in left opening (5).  
6
3
Push down on wind screen (6) until it locks in place.  
4
Warning!  
Check for secure locking by pulling up on the  
wind screen.  
5
P65.00-2039-26  
Important!  
The open end of the hooks must point toward the  
vehicle’s front.  
Wind screen  
171  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
172  
Car care  
Index  
Wind screen  
Removal  
Push left and right side buttons and remove wind  
screen upward.  
Warning!  
To prevent personal injury, remove wind screen if  
rear seats are to be occupied by passengers.  
Note:  
Do not insert foreign objects in openings for the  
wind screen.  
P65.00-2009-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Storing  
Place wind screen in its storage bag, and close the bag.  
Place bag in trunk, and secure it with the provided hook  
and loop fasteners.  
1
2
When the wind screen is not in use, it should be stored  
in the closed storage bag, to prevent possible damage to  
the wind screen or luggage/cargo.  
P65.00-2011-26  
Pull end sections in direction of arrow (1) and fold in  
direction of arrow (2).  
Wind screen  
173  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
174  
Car care  
Index  
Wind screen  
Roller Blind (horizontal)  
To open blind:  
1. Pull out blind on tab (arrow 1) towards vehicles rear.  
Insert guide rod of blind in right rear seat belt outlet  
(arrow 2).  
2
2. Insert other end of rod in left rear seat belt outlet as  
shown with arrow (3).  
1
Important!  
3
Do not place anything on the roller blind.  
To retract blind:  
Hold blind at tab, disengage and guide retraction.  
P65.00-2049-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roller Blind (vertical)  
To open blind:  
1. Fold driver and front passenger seat backrests  
forward.  
2. Pull out on tab, located below rear bench, towards  
vehicle’s front, then pull up and engage blind at  
wind screen.  
To retract blind:  
1. Fold driver and front passenger seat backrests  
forward.  
2. Hold blind at tab, disengage and guide its retraction.  
P65.00-2018-26  
Wind screen  
175  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving instructions ......................205 Cruise control ................................. 214  
Drive sensibly – save fuel ........205 Brake assist system  
Driving  
Control and operation of  
radio transmitters .....................178  
The first 1 000 miles  
(BAS) ........................................... 216  
Drinking and driving ................205  
Pedals ..........................................205  
Power assistance ........................ 206  
Brakes ..........................................206  
Driving off ...................................207  
Parking ........................................ 207  
Tires ............................................. 208  
Snow chains ................................210  
Winter driving instructions ......211  
Deep water ...................................212  
Passenger compartment ............213  
Traveling abroad .........................213  
Antilock brake system  
(ABS) ........................................... 218  
Electronic stability program  
(ESP) ...........................................220  
What you should know  
(1 500 km) .................................179  
Maintenance ...................................179  
Catalytic converter ........................180  
Emission control ............................ 181  
Tele Aid ...........................................182  
Steering lock ...................................192  
Starting and turning off  
the engine ..................................194  
Automatic transmission ...............195  
Parking brake .................................204  
at the gas station .......................224  
Check regularly and  
before a long trip ......................226  
Contents – Driving  
177  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Control and operation of radio transmitters  
Control and operation of radio transmitters  
178  
COMAND, radio and telephone  
Telephones and two-way radio  
Warning!  
Warning!  
Please do not forget that your primary  
Never operate radio transmitters equipped with a  
built-in or attached antenna (i.e. without being  
connected to an external antenna) from inside the  
vehicle while the engine is running. Doing so could  
lead to a malfunction of the vehicle’s electronic  
system, possibly resulting in an accident and  
personal injury.  
responsibility is to drive the vehicle. Only operate  
the COMAND (Cockpit Management and Data  
System), radio or telephone1 if road and traffic  
conditions permit.  
Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph  
(approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is covering  
a distance of approximately 50 feet (approximately  
14 m) every second.  
Radio transmitters, such as a portable telephone or a  
citizens band unit should only be used inside the  
vehicle if they are connected to an antenna that is  
installed on the outside of the vehicle.  
1
Observe all legal requirements.  
Refer to the radio transmitter operation instructions  
regarding use of an external antenna.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
The first 1 000 miles (1 500 km)  
Maintenance  
The more cautiously you treat your vehicle during the  
break-in period, the more satisfied you will be with its  
performance later on. Therefore, drive your vehicle  
during the first 1 000 miles (1 500 km) at moderate  
vehicle and engine speeds.  
Approximately 30 days or 2 000 miles ( 2000 km) prior  
to the next recommended service, the remaining  
distance or days are displayed in the multifunction  
indicator. See Flexible service system (FSS) on  
page 109.  
During this period, avoid heavy loads (full throttle  
driving) and excessive engine speeds.  
We strongly recommend that you have your vehicle  
serviced by your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center, in  
accordance with the Service Booklet at the times called  
for by the FSS.  
Avoid accelerating by kickdown. It is not recommended  
to brake the vehicle by manually shifting to a lower gear.  
We recommend that you select positions “3”, “2” or “1”  
only at moderate speeds (for hill driving).  
Failure to have the vehicle maintained in accordance  
with the Service Booklet at the designated times/  
mileage may result in vehicle damage not covered by  
the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
After 1 000 miles (1 500 km) speeds may be gradually  
increased to the permissible maximum.  
Check regularly and before a long trip, see page 226.  
The first 1 000 miles  
179  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Catalytic converter  
Catalytic converter  
180  
Caution!  
Your Mercedes-Benz is equipped with monolithic type  
catalytic converters, an important element in  
To prevent damage to the catalytic converters, use only  
premium unleaded gasoline in this vehicle.  
conjunction with the oxygen sensors to achieve  
substantial control of the pollutants in the exhaust  
emissions. Keep your vehicle in proper operating  
condition by following our recommended maintenance  
instructions as outlined in your Service Booklet.  
Any noticeable irregularities in engine operation should  
be repaired promptly. Otherwise, excessive unburned  
fuel may reach the catalytic converter causing it to  
overheat, which could start a fire.  
Warning!  
As with any vehicle, do not idle, park or operate  
this vehicle in areas where combustible materials  
such as grass, hay or leaves can come into contact  
with the hot exhaust system, as these materials  
could be ignited and cause a vehicle fire.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Emission control  
Warning!  
Certain systems of the engine serve to keep the toxic  
components of the exhaust gases within permissible  
limits required by law.  
Inhalation of exhaust gas is hazardous to your  
health. All exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide,  
and inhaling it can cause unconsciousness and  
lead to death.  
These systems, of course, will function properly only  
when maintained strictly according to factory  
Do not run the engine in confined areas (such as a  
garage) which are not properly ventilated. If you  
think that exhaust gas fumes are entering the  
vehicle while driving, have the cause determined  
and corrected immediately. If you must drive under  
these conditions, drive only with at least one  
window fully open.  
specifications. Any adjustments on the engine should,  
therefore, be carried out only by qualified Mercedes-  
Benz authorized center technicians. Engine adjustments  
should not be altered in any way. Moreover, the  
specified service jobs must be carried out regularly  
according to Mercedes-Benz servicing requirements.  
For details refer to the Service Booklet.  
Emission control  
181  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tele Aid  
182  
Tele Aid  
Important!  
The speaker volume of a Tele Aid call can be adjusted  
when using the volume control on the multifunction  
steering wheel, for raising press button æ and for  
lowering press button ç.  
The initial activation of the Tele Aid system may only be  
performed by completing the subscriber agreement and  
placing an acquaintance call using the “SOS” button.  
Failure to complete either of these steps will result in a  
system that is not activated. If the system is not  
activated the indicator lamp in the “SOS” button stays  
on after turning electronic key in starter switch to  
position 2 and the message “TELE AID – NOT  
ACTIVATED” will be shown in the multifunction display  
for approx. 10 seconds.  
To activate, press the “SOS” button, the Roadside  
Assistance button or the Information button ¡,  
depending on the type of response required.  
Shortly after the completion of your Acquaintance Call,  
you will receive a user ID and password via first call  
mail. By visiting www.mbusa.com and selecting “Tele  
Aid” (USA only), you will have access to account  
information, remote door unlock, Info Services* profile  
and more.  
If you have any questions regarding activation, please  
call the Response Center at 1-800-756-9018 (in the USA)  
or 1-888-923-8367 (in Canada).  
* Optional – available only with COMAND  
System self-check  
(Telematic Alarm Identification on Demand)  
Initially, after turning the electronic key in starter  
switch to position 2, malfunctions are detected and  
indicated (the indicator lamps in the “SOS” button, the  
Roadside Assistance button and the Information  
button ¡ stay on longer than 10 seconds or do not  
come on). The message “TELE AID – VISIT  
The Tele Aid system consists of three types of response;  
automatic and manual emergency, roadside assistance  
and information.  
The Tele Aid system is operational providing that the  
vehicle’s battery is charged, properly connected, not  
damaged and cellular and GPS coverage is available.  
WORKSHOP” appears for approx. 10 seconds in the  
multifunction display.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Important!  
Once the emergency call is in progress, the indicator  
lamp in the “SOS” button will begin to flash. The  
message “EMERGENCY CALL – CONNECTING CALL”  
appears in the multifunction display. When the  
connection is established, the message “EMERGENCY  
CALL – CALL CONNECTED” appears in the  
multifunction display. All information relevant to the  
emergency, such as the location of the vehicle  
(determined by the GPS satellite location system),  
vehicle model, identification number and color are  
generated.  
Always make sure that the indicator lamps in the  
“SOS” button, in the “Roadside Assistance” button and  
in the “Information” button do not remain illuminated  
constantly in red and the message “TELE AID -VISIT  
WORKSHOP” is not displayed in the multifunction  
display after the system self check.  
If a malfunction is indicated as outlined above, have the  
system checked at the nearest Mercedes-Benz Center as  
soon as possible.  
A voice connection between the Response Center and  
the occupants of the vehicle will be established  
automatically soon after the emergency call has been  
initiated. When a voice connection is established the  
audio system mutes and the message “TELE AID –  
EMERGENCY CALL ACTIVE” appears in the  
Emergency calls  
An emergency call is initiated automatically:  
following an accident in which the Emergency  
Tensioning Retractors (ETR’s) or airbags deploy,  
multifunction display. The Response Center will attempt  
to determine more precisely the nature of the accident  
provided they can speak to an occupant of the vehicle.  
if the antitheft alarm or the tow away alarm stays on  
for more than 20 seconds, see pages 42 and 44.  
An emergency call can also be initiated manually by  
opening the cover next to the inside rear view mirror  
labeled “SOS”, then pressing the button (for longer than  
2 seconds) located under the cover. See below for  
instructions on initiating an emergency call manually.  
Tele Aid  
183  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tele Aid  
184  
The Tele Aid system is available if:  
Warning!  
it has been activated and is operational. Activation  
requires a subscription for monitoring services and  
cellular air time,  
If the indicator lamp in the “SOS” button is  
illuminated continuously and there was no voice  
connection to the Response Center established,  
then the Tele Aid system could not initiate an  
emergency call (e.g. the relevant cellular phone  
network is not available). The message  
the relevant cellular phone network and GPS signals  
are available and pass the information on to the  
response center.  
“EMERGENCY CALL – CALL FAILED” appears in  
the multifunction display for approx. 10 seconds.  
Note:  
Should this occur, assistance must be summoned  
by other means.  
Location of the vehicle on a map is possible if the  
vehicle is able to receive signals from the GPS satellite  
network and pass the information on to the response  
center.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Initiating an emergency call manually  
Warning!  
If you feel at any way in jeopardy when in the  
vehicle (e.g. smoke or fire in the vehicle, vehicle in  
a dangerous road location), please do not wait for  
voice contact after you have pressed the emergency  
button. Carefully leave the vehicle and move to a  
safe location. The Response Center will  
2
automatically contact local emergency officials  
with the vehicle’s approximate location if they  
receive an automatic “SOS” signal and cannot make  
voice contact with the vehicle occupants.  
1
P82.95-2114-26  
Briefly press on cover (1) – the cover will open.  
Press the SOS button (2) briefly (for longer than  
2 seconds). The indicator lamp in the SOS button (2)  
will flash until the emergency call is concluded. Wait for  
a voice connection to the Response Center.  
Close the cover (1) after the emergency call is  
concluded.  
Tele Aid  
185  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tele Aid  
186  
Roadside Assistance button •  
services such as labor and/or towing charges may apply.  
Refer to the Roadside Assistance manual for more  
information.  
Located below the center armrest cover is the Roadside  
Assistance button . Pressing and holding the  
button (for longer than 2 seconds) will initiate a call to a  
Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance dispatcher. The  
button will flash while the call is in progress. The  
message “ROADSIDE ASSISTANCE – CONNECTING  
CALL” will appear in the multifunction display. When  
the connection is established, the message “ROADSIDE  
ASSISTANCE – CALL CONNECTED” appears in the  
multifunction display. The Tele Aid system will transmit  
data generating the vehicle identification number,  
model, color and location (subject to availability of  
cellular and GPS signals).  
These programs are only available in the USA:  
Sign and Drive services: Services such as jump start,  
a few gallons of fuel or the replacement of a flat tire  
with the vehicle spare tire are obtainable,  
Remote Vehicle Diagnostics: This function permits  
the Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance dispatcher  
to download malfunction codes and actual vehicle  
data.  
Notes:  
A voice connection between the Roadside Assistance  
dispatcher and the occupants of the vehicle will be  
established. When a voice connection is established the  
audio system mutes and the message “TELE AID –  
ROADSIDE ASSISTANCE CALL ACTIVE” appears in the  
multifunction display. The nature of the need for  
assistance can then be described. The Mercedes-Benz  
Roadside assistance dispatcher will either dispatch a  
qualified Mercedes-Benz technician or arrange to tow  
your vehicle to the nearest Mercedes-Benz Center. For  
The indicator lamp in the Roadside Assistance  
button remains illuminated in red for approx.  
10 seconds during the system self-check after turning  
electronic key in starter switch to position 2 (together  
with the “SOS” button and the Information  
button ¡).  
See system self-check on page 182 when the indicator  
lamp does not light up in red or stays on longer than  
approximately 10 seconds.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
If the indicator lamp in the Roadside Assistance  
button is illuminated continuously and there was  
no voice connection to the Response Center established,  
then the Tele Aid system could not initiate an Roadside  
Assistance call (e.g. the relevant cellular phone network  
is not available). The message “ROADSIDE  
A voice connection between the Client Assistance  
Center representative and the occupants of the vehicle  
will be established. When a voice connection is  
established the audio system mutes and the message  
“TELE AID – INFO CALL ACTIVE” appears in the  
multifunction display. Information regarding the  
operation of your vehicle, the nearest Mercedes-Benz  
Center or Mercedes-Benz USA products and services is  
available to you.  
ASSISTANCE – CALL FAILED” appears in the  
multifunction display.  
Roadside Assistance calls can be terminated using the  
ì button on the multifunction steering wheel.  
For more details concerning Tele Aid, please visit  
www.mbusa.com and use your ID and password, sent to  
you separately, to learn more (USA only).  
Information button ¡  
Notes:  
Located below the center armrest cover is the  
Information button ¡. Pressing and holding the  
button (for longer than 2 seconds) will initiate a call to  
the Client Assistance Center. The button will flash while  
the call is in progress. The message “INFO –  
CONNECTING CALL” will appear in the multifunction  
display. When the connection is established, the  
message “INFO – CALL CONNECTED” appears in the  
multifunction display. The Tele Aid system will transmit  
data generating the vehicle identification number,  
model, color and location (subject to availability of  
cellular and GPS signals).  
The indicator lamp in the Information button ¡  
remains illuminated in red for approx. 10 seconds  
during the system self-check after turning electronic  
key in starter switch to position 2 (together with the  
“SOS” button and the Roadside Assistance button ).  
See system self-check on page 182 when the indicator  
lamp does not light up in red or stays on longer than  
approximately 10 seconds.  
If the indicator lamp in the Information button ¡ is  
illuminated continuously and there was no voice  
connection to the Response Center established, then the  
Tele Aid  
187  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tele Aid  
188  
Tele Aid system could not initiate an Information call  
(e.g. the relevant cellular phone network is not  
available). The message “INFO – CALL FAILED” appears  
in the multifunction display.  
Upgrade Signals  
Tele Aid system processes calls using the following  
priority.  
Automatic emergency – First priority  
Manual emergency – Second priority  
Roadside assistance – Third priority  
Information – Fourth priority  
Information calls can be terminated using the  
ì button on the multifunction steering wheel.  
Important!  
If the indicator lamps do not start flashing after  
pressing one of the buttons or remain illuminated (in  
red) at any time, the Tele Aid system has detected a fault  
or the service is not currently active, and may not  
initiate a call. Visit your Mercedes-Benz Center and  
have the system checked or contact the Response Center  
at 1-800-756-9018 (in the USA) or 1-888-923-8367 (in  
Canada) as soon as possible.  
Should a higher priority call be initiated while you are  
connected, an upgrade (alternating) tone will be heard,  
and the appropriate indicator lamp will flash. If certain  
information such as vehicle identification number or  
client information is not available, the operator may  
need to retransmit. During this time you will hear a  
chirp and voice contact will be interrupted. Voice  
contact will resume once the retransmission is  
completed. Once a call is concluded, a chirp will be  
heard and the appropriate indicator lamp will stop  
flashing. The COMAND system operation will resume  
(only vehicles with COMAND).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Important!  
When a Tele Aid call has been initiated, the audio  
system or the COMAND system audio (only vehicles  
with COMAND) is muted and the selected mode (radio,  
tape or CD) pauses. The optional cellular phone (if  
installed) switches off. If you must use this phone, the  
vehicle must be parked. Disconnect the coiled cord and  
place the call. The navigation system (if engaged) will  
continue to run. The display in the instrument cluster is  
available for use and spoken commands are only  
available by pressing the RPT button on the COMAND  
unit. A pop-up window will appear in the COMAND  
display to indicate that a Tele Aid call is in progress.  
If the indicator lamp continues to flash or the system  
does not reset, contact the Response Center at  
1-800-756-9018 (in the USA) or 1-888-923-8367 (in  
Canada), or Mercedes-Benz Client Assistance at  
1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1-800-367-6372) in the USA or  
Customer Service at 1-800-387-0100 in Canada.  
Notes:  
The indicator lamp in the respective button flashes until  
the call is concluded. Calls can only be terminated by a  
Response Center or Client Assistance Center  
representative except Roadside Assistance and  
Information calls, which can also be terminated by  
pressing ì button on the multifunction steering  
wheel.  
Tele Aid  
189  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tele Aid  
190  
Remote door unlock  
Notes:  
The remote door unlock feature is available if the  
relevant cellular phone network is available.  
In the case you have your vehicle locked unintentionally  
(e.g. key inside vehicle), and the reserve key is not  
handy, contact the Mercedes-Benz Response Center at  
1-800-756-9018 (in the USA) or 1-888-923-8367 (in  
Canada). You will be asked to provide your password  
which you provided when you completed the subscriber  
agreement.  
The SOS button will flash and the message  
“EMERGENCY CALL – CALL CONNECTED” will appear  
in the multifunction display to indicate receipt of the  
door unlock command.  
Once the vehicle is unlocked, a Response Center  
specialist will attempt to establish voice contact with the  
vehicle occupants.  
Then return to your vehicle and press trunk lock for  
minimum of 20 seconds until the “SOS” button is  
flashing. The message “EMERGENCY CALL – CALL  
CONNECTED” appears in the multifunction display.  
If the trunk lock was pressed for more than 20 seconds  
before door unlock authorization was received by the  
Response Center, you must wait 15 minutes before  
pressing trunk lock again.  
As an alternative, you may unlock the vehicle via  
Internet using the ID and password sent to you shortly  
after the completion of your Acquaintance Call.  
The Response Center will then unlock your vehicle with  
the remote door unlocking feature.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Stolen vehicle tracking services  
Once information is available, the message “NEW INFO  
RECEIVED - READ LATER WHEN STOPPED?” will  
appear. Select “Yes”. With the vehicle stopped in a safe  
location press SVC, then select “View Info Service of  
mm.dd.yyyy hh.mm”. Messages will be retained for  
30 minutes once the ignition is switched off.  
In the event your vehicle was stolen, report the incident  
to the police who will issue a numbered incident report.  
Pass this number on to the Mercedes-Benz Response  
Center.  
The Response Center will then attempt to covertly  
contact the vehicle’s Tele Aid system. Once the vehicle  
is located, the Response Center will contact the local  
Law Enforcement and you. The vehicle’s location will  
only be provided to Law Enforcement.  
Important!  
Tele Aid utilizes the cellular network for  
communication and the GPS (Global Positioning  
System) satellites for vehicle location. If either of these  
signals are unavailable, the Tele Aid system may not  
function and if this occurs, assistance must be  
summoned by other means.  
Info Services (optional, except Canada)  
(only vehicles with COMAND)  
Info Services categories include news, sports, stocks,  
weather and calendar reminders. Choices can be  
selected via www.mbusa.com or by calling 1-800-FOR-  
MERcedes.  
Warning!  
If the indicator lamp in the “SOS” button does not  
illuminate during or remains illuminated after the  
system self-check or if the message “TELE AID –  
VISIT WORKSHOP” appears in the multifunction  
display, have the system checked at the nearest  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
To request Info Services press the SVC button on the  
COMAND system, then select “SEND NEW REQUEST  
FOR INFO SERVICE”. “NEW INFO SERVICE REQUEST  
TRANSMITTED” will appear in the COMAND display  
and call status messages will appear in the  
multifunction display.  
Tele Aid  
191  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Steering lock  
192  
Steering lock  
1 Steering is unlocked.  
(If necessary, move steering wheel slightly to allow  
the electronic key to be turned clockwise to  
position 1.) Most electrical consumers can be  
operated. For detailed information see respective  
subjects.  
2 Driving position.  
3 Starting position.  
See page 194 for starting and turning off the engine.  
Warning!  
When leaving the vehicle always remove the  
electronic key from the steering lock, and lock the  
vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the  
vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.  
Unsupervised use of vehicle equipment may cause  
serious personal injury.  
P82.00-2073-26  
0 The electronic key can be withdrawn in this position  
only. The steering is locked when the electronic key  
is removed from the steering lock. If necessary,  
move steering wheel slightly to allow the locking  
mechanism to engage. The electronic key can only  
be removed with the selector lever in position “P”.  
After removing the electronic key or with the  
electronic key in steering lock position 0, the  
selector lever is locked in position “P”.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Important!  
Notes:  
A warning sounds when the driver’s door is opened  
while the electronic key is in steering lock position 1  
or 0.  
If the electronic key is left in the steering lock position 0  
for an extended period of time, it can no longer be  
turned in the lock. In this case, remove electronic key  
from steering lock and reinsert.  
With the engine at idle speed, the charging rate of the  
alternator (output) is limited.  
Caution!  
It is therefore recommended that you turn off  
unnecessary electrical consumers while driving in stop-  
and-go traffic. This precaution helps to avoid draining of  
the battery.  
To prevent accelerated battery discharge and a possible  
dead battery, always remove the electronic key from the  
steering lock. Do not leave the electronic key in steering  
lock position 0.  
Unnecessary strain on the battery and charging system  
may be minimized by turning off the following power  
consumers, for example: Heated seats, rear window  
defroster. In addition, the automatic climate air volume  
control should be set to the lowest position.  
The steering lock can only be unlocked with the vehicle  
battery properly charged and connected.  
Steering lock  
193  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Starting and turning off the engine  
194  
Starting and turning off the engine  
Important!  
Due to the installed starter non-repeat feature, the  
electronic key must be turned completely to the left  
before attempting to start the engine again.  
Before starting  
Ensure that parking brake is engaged and that selector  
lever is in position “P” or “N”. Turn electronic key in  
steering lock to position 2.  
In areas where temperatures frequently drop below -4 °F  
(-20°C) we recommend that an engine block heater be  
installed. Your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center will  
advise you on this subject.  
Starting  
Do not depress accelerator.  
Turning off  
Briefly turn electronic key in steering lock clockwise to  
the stop and release. The starter will engage until the  
engine is running.  
Turn the electronic key in the steering lock to position 0  
to stop the engine.  
The electronic key can only be removed with the  
selector lever in position “P”.  
If engine will not run, and the starting procedure stops,  
turn electronic key completely to the left and repeat  
starting the engine.  
After several unsuccessful attempts, have the system  
checked at the nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Automatic transmission  
The automatic transmission selects individual gears  
automatically, dependent upon  
Selector lever position  
Program mode selector  
Accelerator position  
Vehicle speed  
The gear shifting process is continuously adapted,  
dependent on the driving style, the driving situation  
and the road characteristics.  
Important!  
When parking the vehicle or before working on the  
vehicle with the engine running, firmly depress the  
parking brake pedal and shift the selector lever into “P”.  
Automatic transmission  
195  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Automatic transmission  
Driving  
196  
Important!  
The selector lever is automatically locked while in  
position “P”. To move the selector lever out of  
position “P”, the service brake pedal must be firmly  
depressed before the shift lock will release.  
After selecting any driving position from “N” or “P”,  
wait a moment to allow the gear to fully engage before  
accelerating, especially when the engine is cold.  
Shift selector lever to the desired position only when the  
engine is idling normally and the service brake is  
applied. Do not release the brake until ready to drive.  
The vehicle may otherwise start creeping when the  
selector lever is in drive or reverse position.  
Accelerator position  
Partial throttle = early upshifting = normal acceleration  
Full throttle = later upshifting = rapid acceleration  
Kickdown (depressing the accelerator beyond full  
throttle) = downshifting to a lower gear = maximum  
acceleration. Once the desired speed is attained, ease up  
on the accelerator – the transmission shifts up again.  
Warning!  
It is dangerous to shift the selector lever out of “P”  
or “N” if the engine speed is higher than idle speed.  
If your foot is not firmly on the brake pedal, the  
vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or in  
reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle and  
hit someone or something. Only shift into gear  
when the engine is idling normally and when your  
right foot is firmly on the brake pedal.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Stopping  
Rocking a vehicle free in this manner may cause the  
ABS or traction system malfunction indicator lamp to  
come on. Turn off and restart the engine to clear the  
malfunction indication.  
For brief stops, e.g. at traffic lights, leave the  
transmission in gear and hold vehicle with the service  
brake.  
For longer stops with the engine idling, shift into “N”  
or “P” and hold the vehicle with the service brake.  
Warning!  
Getting out of your vehicle with the selector lever  
not fully engaged in position “P” is dangerous.  
Also, when parked on an incline, position “P” alone  
may not prevent your vehicle from moving,  
possibly hitting people or objects.  
When stopping the vehicle on an uphill gradient, do not  
hold it with the accelerator, use the brake. This avoids  
unnecessary transmission heat build up.  
Always set the parking brake in addition to shifting  
to position “P”, see page 204 for parking brake.  
Maneuvering  
To maneuver in tight areas, e.g. when pulling into a  
parking space, control the vehicle speed by gradually  
releasing the brakes. Accelerate gently and never  
abruptly step on the accelerator.  
When parked on an incline, also turn front wheel  
against curb.  
Warning!  
To rock a vehicle out of soft ground (mud or snow),  
alternately shift from forward to reverse, while applying  
slight partial throttle.  
When leaving the vehicle, always remove the  
electronic key from the steering lock, and lock the  
vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the  
vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.  
Children could move the gear selector lever from  
position “P”, which could result in an accident or  
serious personal injury.  
Automatic transmission  
197  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Automatic transmission  
Selector lever position  
198  
Park position  
The park position is to be used when parking the  
vehicle. Engage only with the vehicle stopped.  
The park position is not intended to serve as a  
brake when the vehicle is parked. Rather, the  
driver should always use the parking brake in  
addition to placing the selector lever in park to  
secure the vehicle.  
Note:  
The electronic key can only be removed from the  
steering lock with the selector lever in  
position “P”. With the electronic key removed, the  
selector lever is locked in position “P”.  
With a malfunction in the vehicle’s electrical  
system the selector lever could remain locked in  
position “P”. To unlock the selector lever  
manually, see page 279.  
The current selector lever position is indicated in the  
gear range indicator display. The automatic gear  
shifting process can be adapted to specific operating  
conditions using the selector lever.  
Reverse gear  
Shift to reverse gear only with the vehicle  
stopped.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Dependent on the program mode selector switch  
position “S” or “W” the maximum speed in the  
reverse gear is different. However, it is not  
possible to change the program mode while in  
reverse.  
Gear selection for special circumstances  
The transmission gear ranges for special circumstances  
can be selected by pressing the selector lever to the  
right or the left with the selector lever in position “D”.  
The gear range currently selected is indicated in the  
instrument cluster display.  
Neutral  
No power is transmitted from the engine to the  
drive axle. When the brakes are released, the  
vehicle can be moved freely (pushed or towed). Do  
not engage “N” while driving except to coast  
when the vehicle is in danger of skidding (e.g. on  
icy roads, see winter driving instructions on  
page 211).  
Briefly press selector lever in the ç direction:  
The transmission downshifts, one gear at a time, in the  
order “4”, “3”, “2”, “1”.  
Press and hold selector lever in the ç direction:  
The selector lever position display will switch to the  
gear range currently selected by the automatic  
transmission.  
The transmission will only shift down one gear if the  
gear range currently selected has already shifted to its  
highest possible gear.  
Important!  
Coasting the vehicle, or driving for any other  
reason with selector lever in “N” can result in  
transmission damage that is not covered by the  
Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Briefly press selector lever in the æ direction:  
The transmission will shift from the current gear range  
to the next higher gear range. If the transmission is  
already in gear range “D”, an additional upshift of one  
gear is possible.  
The transmission automatically upshifts through  
5th gear. Position “D” provides optimum driving  
characteristics under all normal operating  
conditions.  
Automatic transmission  
199  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Automatic transmission  
200  
Press and hold selector lever in the æ direction:  
The transmission will shift from the current gear  
directly to gear range “D”.  
During the brief warm-up period this delayed upshift  
and increased engine noise might be perceived as a  
malfunction. However, neither the engine nor  
transmission are negatively affected by this mode of  
operation.  
Warning!  
The delayed upshift is effective with vehicle speeds  
below 31 mph (50 km/h) at partial throttle and engine  
temperatures below 95°F (35°C).  
On slippery road surfaces, never downshift in order  
to obtain braking action. This could result in drive  
wheel slip and reduced vehicle control. Your  
vehicle’s ABS will not prevent this type of loss of  
control.  
To avoid overrevving the engine when the selector lever  
is moved to a lower gear range, the transmission will not  
shift to a lower gear, if the engine’s revolutions per  
minute limit would be exceeded. In this case there will  
be no downshift, even when the vehicle speed reaches  
the engine’s RPM limit of that gear, e.g. by applying the  
service brakes.  
Important!  
With transmission in gear range “D”, “4” or “3”,  
upshifting from 1st to 2nd to 3rd gear is delayed  
depending on vehicle speed and engine temperature.  
This allows the catalytic converter to heat up more  
quickly to operating temperatures.  
To prevent the engine from laboring at low RPM when  
driving uphill gradients or with your vehicle heavily  
loaded, the automatic transmission will downshift when  
necessary to maintain engine RPM within the best  
torque range.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Gear ranges:  
Upshift through 4th gear only. Suitable for  
Upshift through 2nd gear only. For driving in  
mountainous regions or under extreme operating  
conditions. This gear selection will allow use of  
the engine’s braking power when descending  
steep grades.  
performance driving.  
Upshift through 3rd gear only. Suitable for  
moderately steep hills. Since the transmission  
does not shift higher than 3rd gear, this gear  
selection will allow use of the engine’s braking  
power downhill.  
Use this position, which makes maximum use of  
the engine’s braking effect, while descending  
very steep or lengthy downgrades and only at  
speeds below 40 mph (60 km/h).  
Automatic transmission  
201  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Automatic transmission  
Program mode selector switch  
202  
Accelerator Operation:  
Fast on = depressing the accelerator pedal quickly  
(not into kickdown position) while driving  
continuously, rather than depressing the  
accelerator pedal in the usual manner, will cause  
the automatic transmission to shift down into a  
lower gear. This gear shifting process is  
dependent on the current vehicle speed.  
Fast off = there will be no upshift when releasing  
the accelerator pedal quickly, e.g. using the  
engine’s braking power during performance  
driving.  
1
W
Winter/Wet (snow and ice) mode  
Press switch on symbol “W”. The vehicle starts  
out in 2nd gear, except with selector lever in 1st  
gear, or with accelerator pedal in kick-down  
position.  
The transmission is provided with a selector switch (1)  
for Standard “S” and Winter/Wet (snow and ice) “W”  
program modes.  
The “W” mode helps to improve traction and  
driving stability of the vehicle.  
S
Standard mode  
Press switch on symbol “S”. Use this mode for all  
regular driving.  
The gear shifting process occurs at lower vehicle  
and engine speeds than in the “S” program mode.  
The vehicle starts out in 1st gear.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Caution!  
In this mode only the 2nd gear or reverse gear can be  
activated.  
Never change the program mode when the selector lever  
is out of position “P”. It could result in a change of  
driving characteristics for which you may not be  
prepared.  
To engage 2nd gear or reverse:  
1. Stop the vehicle.  
2. Move selector lever to position “P”.  
3. Turn off the engine.  
Important!  
Always be certain of the program mode selected since  
the vehicle driving characteristics change with the  
selection of the program mode.  
4. Wait approx. 10 seconds.  
5. Restart the engine.  
Dependent on the program mode selector switch  
position “S” or “W” and the gear selector lever in  
position “R”, the ratio of power transmission changes.  
6. Move selector lever to position “D” (for 2nd gear), or  
move selector lever to position “R” (for reverse gear).  
Have the transmission checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
Emergency operation (Limp home mode)  
If vehicle acceleration worsens or the transmission no  
longer shifts, the transmission is most likely operating  
in Limp home mode which engages when there is a  
malfunction of the transmission. This condition may be  
accompanied by the “CHECK ENGINE” malfunction  
indicator lamp in the instrument cluster coming on.  
Automatic transmission  
203  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Parking brake  
204  
Parking brake  
To engage, firmly depress parking brake pedal. When  
the electronic key is in steering lock position 2, the  
brake warning lamp in the instrument cluster should  
come on brightly.  
To release the parking brake, pull handle on instrument  
panel. The brake warning lamp in the instrument  
cluster should go out.  
A warning sounds, if you start to drive without having  
released the parking brake.  
Also see brake warning lamp on page 229.  
Warning!  
When leaving the vehicle always remove the  
electronic key from the steering lock, and lock the  
vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the  
vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.  
Children could release the parking brake, which  
could result in an accident or serious injury.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Driving instructions  
Drinking and driving  
Warning!  
Drive sensibly – save fuel  
Drinking or taking drugs and driving can be a very  
dangerous combination. Even a small amount of  
alcohol or drugs can affect your reflexes,  
perceptions and judgement.  
Fuel consumption, to a great extent, depends on driving  
habits and operating conditions.  
To save fuel you should:  
The possibility of a serious or even fatal accident is  
sharply increased when you drink or take drugs  
and drive.  
keep tires at the recommended inflation pressures,  
remove unnecessary loads,  
allow engine to warm up under low load use,  
avoid frequent acceleration and deceleration,  
Please don’t drink or take drugs and drive or allow  
anyone to drive after drinking or taking drugs.  
have all maintenance work performed at regular  
Pedals  
intervals by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Fuel consumption is also increased by driving in cold  
weather, in stop-and-go traffic, on short trips and in hilly  
country.  
Warning!  
Keep driver’s foot area clear at all times. Objects  
stored in this area may impair pedal movement.  
Driving instructions  
205  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
       
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving instructions  
Power assistance  
206  
The condition of the parking brake system is checked  
each time the vehicle is in the shop for the required  
maintenance service.  
Warning!  
If the parking brake is released and the brake warning  
lamp in the instrument cluster stays on, the brake fluid  
level in the reservoir is too low.  
When the engine is not running, the brake and  
steering systems are without power assistance.  
Under these circumstances, a much greater effort is  
necessary to stop or steer the vehicle.  
Brake pad wear or a leak in the system may be the  
reason for low brake fluid in the reservoir.  
Brakes  
Have the brake system inspected at an authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center immediately.  
Warning!  
All checks and service work on the brake system should  
be carried out by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
After driving in heavy rain for some time without  
applying the brakes or through water deep enough  
to wet brake components, the first braking action  
may be somewhat reduced and increased pedal  
pressure may be necessary to obtain expected  
braking effect. Be sure to maintain a safe distance  
from vehicles in front.  
Install only brake pads and brake fluid recommended by  
Mercedes-Benz.  
Warning!  
If other than recommended brake pads are  
installed, or other than recommended brake fluid  
is used, the braking properties of the vehicle can be  
degraded to an extent that safe braking is  
substantially impaired. This could result in an  
accident.  
Resting your foot on the brake pedal will cause  
excessive and premature wear of the brake pads.  
It can also result in the brakes overheating thereby  
significantly reducing their effectiveness. It may  
not be possible to stop the vehicle in sufficient time  
to avoid an accident.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Caution!  
Parking  
When driving down long and steep grades, relieve the  
load on the brakes by shifting into a lower gear to use  
the engine’s braking power. This helps prevent  
Warning!  
To reduce the risk of personal injury as a result of  
vehicle movement, before turning off the engine  
and leaving the vehicle, always:  
overheating of the brakes and reduces brake pad wear.  
After hard braking, it is advisable to drive on for some  
time, rather than immediately parking, so the air stream  
will cool down the brakes faster.  
1. Keep right foot on the service brake pedal.  
2. Firmly depress parking brake pedal.  
3. Move the selector lever to position “P”.  
4. Slowly release the service brake pedal.  
5. Turn front wheels towards the road curb.  
Driving off  
Apply the service brakes to test them briefly after  
driving off. Perform this procedure only when the road  
is clear of other traffic.  
6. Turn the electronic key to steering lock  
position 0 and remove.  
Warm up the engine smoothly. Do not place full load on  
the engine until the operating temperature has been  
reached.  
7. Take the electronic key and lock vehicle when  
leaving.  
When starting off on a slippery surface, do not allow one  
drive wheel to spin for an extended period with the ESP  
switched off. Doing so may cause serious damage to the  
drive train which is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz  
Limited Warranty.  
Important!  
It is advisable to set the parking brake whenever  
parking or leaving the vehicle. In addition, move  
selector lever to position “P”.  
When parking on hills, always set the parking brake.  
Driving instructions  
207  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving instructions  
Tires  
208  
Warning!  
If you feel a sudden significant vibration or ride  
disturbance, or you suspect that possible damage to  
your vehicle has occurred, you should turn on the  
hazard warning flashers, carefully slow down, and  
drive with caution to an area which is a safe  
distance from the roadway.  
Inspect the tires and under the vehicle for possible  
damage. If the vehicle or tires appear unsafe, have  
it towed to the nearest Mercedes-Benz Center or  
tire dealer for repairs.  
Warning!  
Tread wear indicators (TWI) are required by law. These  
indicators are located in six places on the tread  
circumference and become visible at a tread depth of  
approximately 1/16 in (1.5 mm), at which point the tire is  
considered worn and should be replaced.  
Do not allow your tires to wear down too far. As  
tread depth approaches 1/16 in (1.5 mm), the  
adhesion properties on a wet road are sharply  
reduced.  
Depending upon the weather and/or road surface  
(conditions), the tire traction varies widely.  
The tread wear indicator appears as a solid band across  
the tread.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Specified tire pressures must be maintained. This  
applies particularly if the tires are subjected to high  
loads (e.g. high speeds, heavy loads, high ambient  
temperatures).  
Tire traction  
The safe speed on a wet, snow covered or icy road is  
always lower than on a dry road.  
You should pay particular attention to the condition of  
the road whenever the outside temperatures are close to  
the freezing point.  
Warning!  
Do not drive with a flat tire. A flat tire affects the  
ability to steer or brake the vehicle. You may lose  
control of the vehicle. Continued driving with a flat  
tire or driving at high speed with a flat tire will  
cause excessive heat build-up and possibly a fire.  
Warning!  
If ice has formed on the road, tire traction will be  
substantially reduced. Under such weather  
conditions, drive, steer and brake with extreme  
caution.  
Aquaplaning  
Depending on the depth of the water layer on the road,  
aquaplaning may occur, even at low speeds and with  
new tires. Reduce vehicle speed, avoid track grooves in  
the road and apply brakes cautiously in the rain.  
We recommend M+S rated radial-ply tires for the winter  
season for all four wheels to insure normal balanced  
handling characteristics. On packed snow, they can  
reduce your stopping distance as compared with  
summer tires. Stopping distance, however, is still  
considerably greater than when the road is not snow or  
ice covered.  
Driving instructions  
209  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving instructions  
Tire speed rating  
CLK 320:  
210  
Snow chains  
Use only snow chains that are tested and recommended  
by Mercedes-Benz. Your authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center will be glad to advise you on this subject.  
Your vehicle is factory equipped with “H”-rated tires,  
which have a speed rating of 130 mph (210 km/h).  
CLK 430:  
Chains should only be used on the rear wheels. Follow  
the manufacturer’s mounting instructions.  
Your vehicle is factory equipped with “W”-rated tires,  
which are permissible for speeds up to 168 mph  
(270 km/h).  
Snow chains should only be driven on snow covered  
roads at speeds not to exceed 30 mph (50 km/h).  
Remove chains as soon as possible when driving on  
roads without snow.  
An electronic speed limiter prevents your vehicle from  
exceeding a speed of 130 mph (210 km/h).  
Despite the tire rating, local speed limits should be  
obeyed. Use prudent driving speeds appropriate to  
prevailing conditions.  
When driving with snow chains, press the ESP control  
switch to OFF, refer to page 222.  
Important!  
Warning!  
Use of snow chains is not permissible with tire sizes  
225/45 R17 and 245/40 R17.  
Even when permitted by law, never operate a  
vehicle at speeds greater than the maximum speed  
rating of the tires.  
Exceeding the maximum speed for which tires are  
rated can lead to sudden tire failure causing loss of  
vehicle control and resulting in personal injury  
and possible death.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Winter driving instructions  
If the vehicle is parked after being driven on salt treated  
roads, the braking efficiency should be tested as soon as  
possible after driving is resumed while observing the  
safety rules in the previous paragraph.  
The most important rule for slippery or icy roads is to  
drive sensibly and to avoid abrupt acceleration, braking  
and steering maneuvers. Do not use the cruise control  
system under such conditions.  
Warning!  
When the vehicle is in danger of skidding, move  
selector lever to position “N”. Try to keep the vehicle  
under control by corrective steering action.  
If the vehicle becomes stuck in snow, make sure  
that snow is kept clear of the exhaust pipe and  
from around the vehicle with engine running.  
Otherwise, deadly carbon monoxide (CO) gases may  
enter vehicle interior resulting in unconsciousness  
and death.  
Road salts and chemicals can adversely affect braking  
efficiency. Increased pedal force may become necessary  
to produce the normal brake effect. We therefore  
recommend depressing the brake pedal periodically  
when traveling at length on salt-strewn roads. This can  
bring road salt impaired braking efficiency back to  
normal. A prerequisite is, however, that this be done  
without endangering other drivers on the road.  
To assure sufficient fresh air ventilation, open a  
window slightly on the side of the vehicle not  
facing the wind.  
Driving instructions  
211  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving instructions  
Winter driving  
212  
In winter operation, the maximum effectiveness of the  
antilock brake system (ABS) or of the electronic stability  
program (ESP) can only be achieved with M+S rated  
radial-ply tires and/or snow chains recommended by  
Mercedes-Benz. Snow chains maximize performance.  
Have your vehicle winterized at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center before the onset of winter.  
Change the engine oil if the engine contains an oil  
which is not approved for winter operation. For  
viscosity (SAE/CCMC class) and filling quantity, see  
page 317.  
For driving instructions with snow chains, see page 210.  
Deep water  
Caution!  
Check engine coolant anticorrosion/antifreeze  
concentration.  
Additive for the windshield washer and headlamp  
cleaning system: Add MB Concentrate “S” to a  
premixed windshield washer solvent/antifreeze  
which is formulated for below freezing temperatures  
see page 259.  
Do not drive through flooded areas or water of unknown  
depth.  
If you must drive through deep water, drive slowly to  
prevent water from entering the engine compartment or  
passenger compartment, being ingested by the air  
intake, possibly causing damage to electrical  
components or wiring, to engine or transmission that is  
not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Test battery: Battery capacity drops with decreasing  
ambient temperature. A well charged battery helps  
to ensure that the engine can be started, even at low  
ambient temperatures.  
Block heater (Canada only)  
Tires: We recommend M+S rated radial-ply tires on  
all four wheels for the winter season. Observe  
permissible maximum speed for M+S rated  
radial-ply tires and the legal speed limit.  
The engine is equipped with a block heater.  
The electrical cable may be installed at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Passenger compartment  
Warning!  
Traveling abroad  
Abroad, there is a widely-spread Mercedes-Benz service  
network at your disposal. If you plan to travel into areas  
which are not listed in the index of your Mercedes-Benz  
Center directory, you should request pertinent  
information from your authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center.  
Always fasten items being carried as securely as  
possible.  
In an accident, during hard braking or sudden  
maneuvers, loose items will be thrown around  
inside the vehicle, and cause injury to vehicle  
occupants unless the items are securely fastened in  
the vehicle.  
The trunk is the preferred place to carry objects.  
Driving instructions  
213  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
214  
Cruise control  
1 Accelerate and set:  
Lift lever briefly to set speed.  
Hold lever up to accelerate.  
1
2 Decelerate and set:  
Depress lever briefly to set speed.  
Hold lever down to decelerate.  
3
Normally the vehicle is accelerated to the desired  
speed with the accelerator.  
Speed is set by briefly pushing the lever to  
position 1 or 2. The accelerator can then be  
released.  
4
The speed can be increased (e.g. for passing) by  
using the accelerator. After the accelerator is  
released, the previously set speed will be resumed  
automatically.  
2
The cruise control allows you to drive in a more relaxed  
manner, for example over long distances, as it  
automatically maintains the set speed by actively  
regulating the throttle setting.  
If a set speed is to be increased or decreased  
slightly, e. g. to adapt to the traffic flow, hold lever in  
position 1 or 2 until the desired speed is reached, or  
briefly tip the lever in the appropriate direction for  
increases or decreases in 0.6 mph (1 km/h)  
increments. When the lever is released, the newly  
set speed remains.  
Any given speed above approximately 25 mph  
(40 km/h) can be maintained with the cruise control by  
operating the lever.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3 Canceling  
Important!  
To cancel the cruise control, briefly push lever to  
position 3.  
Moving gear selector lever to position “N” switches the  
cruise control off.  
When you step on the brake pedal or the vehicle  
speed drops below approx. 25 mph (40 km/h), for  
example when driving upgrade, the cruise control  
will be canceled.  
Warning!  
Only use the cruise control if the traffic and  
weather conditions make it advisable to travel at a  
steady speed.  
If the cruise control cancels by itself and remains  
inoperative until the engine is restarted, have the  
system checked at your authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center as soon as possible.  
• The use of cruise control can be dangerous on  
winding roads or in heavy traffic because  
conditions do not allow safe driving at a steady  
speed.  
4 Resume  
• The use of cruise control can be dangerous on  
slippery roads. Rapid changes in tire adhesion  
can result in wheel spin and loss of control.  
If the lever is briefly pushed to position 4 when  
driving at a speed exceeding approx. 25 mph  
(40 km/h), the vehicle resumes the speed which  
was set prior to the cancellation of the cruise  
control. The last memorized speed is canceled when  
the electronic key in the steering lock is turned to  
position 1 or 0.  
The “Resume” function should only be operated if  
the driver is fully aware of the previously set speed  
and wishes to resume this particular preset speed.  
Driving systems  
215  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
216  
Notes:  
Brake assist system (BAS)  
Warning!  
If the engine does not brake the vehicle sufficiently  
while driving on a downgrade, the speed you set on the  
cruise control may be exceeded. In this case the  
automatic transmission shifts down (max. to 3rd gear)  
to maintain the set cruise control speed by using the  
engine’s braking power.  
BAS cannot prevent the natural laws of physics  
from acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase  
braking efficiency beyond that afforded by the  
condition of the vehicle brakes and tires or the  
traction afforded. The BAS cannot prevent  
accidents, including those resulting from excessive  
speed in turns, following another vehicle too  
closely, or aquaplaning. Only a safe, attentive, and  
skillful driver can prevent accidents. The  
capabilities of a BAS equipped vehicle must never  
be exploited in a reckless or dangerous manner  
which could jeopardize the user’s safety or the  
safety of others.  
As soon as the grade eases, the automatic transmission  
shifts up again dependent on the selector lever position.  
Nevertheless, in some cases you may have to step on the  
brake pedal to slow down. In this case the cruise control  
is switched off.  
Use the lever to resume the previously set speed.  
The BAS is designed to maximize the vehicle’s braking  
capability during emergency braking maneuvers by  
having maximum power boost applied to the brakes  
more quickly in emergency braking conditions than  
might otherwise be afforded solely by the driver’s  
braking style. This can help reduce braking distances  
over what ordinary driving and braking style might do.  
The BAS complements the antilock brake system (ABS).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Applying the brakes very quickly results in maximum  
BAS assistance.  
If the charging voltage falls below 10 volts, the  
malfunction indicator lamp comes on and the BAS is  
switched off. When the voltage is above this value again,  
the malfunction indicator lamp should go out and the  
BAS is operational.  
To receive the benefit of the system you must apply  
continuous full braking power during the stopping  
sequence. Do not reduce brake pedal pressure.  
With the ABS malfunctioning, the BAS is also switched  
off. Both malfunction indicator lamps come on with the  
engine running.  
Once the brake pedal is released, the BAS is deactivated.  
The malfunction indicator lamp for the electronic  
stability program (ESP) is combined with the BAS  
malfunction indicator lamp.  
If the BAS warning message is displayed, have the BAS  
or ESP checked at your authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center as soon as possible.  
The BAS/ESP malfunction indicator lamp in the  
instrument cluster comes on with the electronic key in  
steering lock position 2 and should go out with the  
engine running.  
If the BAS/ESP malfunction indicator lamp comes on  
permanently while the engine is running, a malfunction  
has been detected in either system. As a result, it is  
possible that now only partial engine output will be  
available. If the BAS malfunctions, the brake system  
functions in the usual manner, but without BAS.  
Driving systems  
217  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
218  
Antilock brake system (ABS)  
At the instant one of the wheels is about to lock up, a  
slight pulsation can be felt in the brake pedal,  
indicating that the ABS is in the regulating mode. Keep  
firm and steady pressure on the brake pedal while  
experiencing the pulsation.  
Warning!  
Do not pump the brake pedal, rather use firm,  
steady brake pedal pressure. Pumping the brake  
pedal defeats the purpose for ABS and significantly  
reduces braking effectiveness.  
Continuous steady brake pedal pressure results in  
applying the advantages of the ABS, namely braking  
power and ability to steer the vehicle.  
Important!  
In the case of an emergency brake maneuver keep  
continuous full pressure on the brake pedal. In this  
manner only can the ABS be most effective.  
The ABS improves steering control of the vehicle during  
hard braking maneuvers.  
On slippery road surfaces, the ABS will respond even  
with light brake pedal pressure because of the  
increased likelihood of locking wheels. The pulsating  
brake pedal can be an indication of hazardous road  
conditions and functions as a reminder to take extra  
care while driving.  
The ABS prevents the wheels from locking up above a  
vehicle speed of approximately 5 mph (8 km/h)  
independent of road surface conditions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ABS control  
If the ABS malfunction indicator lamp stays illuminated,  
have the system checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
The ABS malfunction indicator lamp - in the  
instrument cluster comes on with the electronic key in  
steering lock position 2 and should go out with the  
engine running.  
Warning!  
ABS cannot prevent the natural laws of physics  
from acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase  
braking or steering efficiency beyond that afforded  
by the condition of the vehicle brakes and tires or  
the traction afforded. The ABS cannot prevent  
accidents, including those resulting from excessive  
speed in turns, following another vehicle too  
closely, or aquaplaning. Only a safe, attentive, and  
skillful driver can prevent accidents. The  
capabilities of an ABS equipped vehicle must never  
be exploited in a reckless or dangerous manner  
which could jeopardize the user’s safety or the  
safety of others.  
When the ABS malfunction indicator lamp in the  
instrument cluster comes on while the engine is  
running, it indicates that the ABS has detected a  
malfunction and has switched off. In this case, the brake  
system functions in the usual manner, but without  
antilock assistance.  
For ABS malfunction indicator lamp, see page 231.  
With the ABS malfunctioning, the BAS and ESP are also  
switched off. Both malfunction indicator lamps come on  
with the engine running.  
If the charging voltage falls below 10 volts, the  
malfunction indicator lamp comes on and the ABS is  
switched off. When the voltage is above this value again,  
the malfunction indicator lamp should go out and the  
ABS is operational.  
Note:  
To alert following vehicles to slippery road conditions  
you discover, operate your hazard warning flashers as  
appropriate.  
Driving systems  
219  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
220  
Electronic stability program (ESP)  
Important!  
If the ESP warning lamp v flashes:  
Warning!  
During take-off apply as little throttle as possible.  
ESP cannot prevent the natural laws of physics  
from acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase the  
traction afforded. The ESP cannot prevent  
accidents, including those resulting from excessive  
speed in turns, or aquaplaning. Only a safe,  
attentive, and skillful driver can prevent accidents.  
The capabilities of an ESP equipped vehicle must  
never be exploited in a reckless or dangerous  
manner which could jeopardize the user’s safety or  
the safety of others.  
While driving ease up on the accelerator.  
Adapt your speed and driving to the prevailing road  
conditions.  
Do not switch off the ESP.  
Caution!  
If the vehicle is towed with the front axle raised (see  
towing the vehicle on page 276), the engine must be  
shut off (electronic key in steering lock position 0 or 1).  
Otherwise, the ESP will immediately be engaged and  
will apply the rear wheel brakes.  
The ESP enhances directional control and reduces  
driving wheel spin of the vehicle under various driving  
conditions.  
Over/understeering of the vehicle is counteracted by  
applying brakes to the appropriate wheel to create a  
countervailing vehicle movement. Engine torque is also  
limited. The ESP warning lamp, located in the  
speedometer dial, starts to flash when ESP is in  
operation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Notes:  
Driving the vehicle with varied size tires will cause the  
wheels to rotate at different speeds, therefore the ESP  
may activate (yellow ESP warning lamp in speedometer  
dial comes on). For this reason, all wheels, including the  
spare wheel, must have the same tire outside diameter.  
The malfunction indicator lamp ¿ for the ESP is  
combined with that of the BAS.  
The yellow BAS/ESP malfunction indicator lamp in the  
instrument cluster and the yellow ESP warning  
lamp v in the speedometer dial come on with the  
electronic key in steering lock position 2. They should  
go out with the engine running.  
When testing the parking brake on a brake test  
dynamometer, the engine must be shut off. Otherwise,  
the ESP will immediately be engaged and will apply the  
rear wheel brakes.  
If the BAS/ESP malfunction indicator lamp comes on  
continuously with the engine running, a malfunction  
has been detected in either system. Only partial engine  
output will be available.  
In winter operation, the maximum effectiveness of the  
ESP is only achieved with Mercedes-Benz recommended  
M+S rated radial-ply tires and/or snow chains.  
If the BAS malfunctions, the brake system functions in  
the usual manner, but without BAS.  
Synchronizing ESP  
If the power supply was interrupted (battery  
disconnected or empty), the BAS/ESP malfunction  
indicator lamp may be illuminated with the engine  
running.  
If the ESP warning message is displayed, have the BAS  
or ESP checked at your authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center as soon as possible.  
For ESP warning message, see page 245.  
Turn steering wheel completely to the left and then to  
the right. The BAS/ESP malfunction indicator lamp  
should go out.  
With the ABS malfunctioning, the ESP is also switched  
off.  
Driving systems  
221  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Driving systems  
222  
ESP control switch  
To improve the vehicle’s traction when driving with  
snow chains, or starting off in deep snow, sand or gravel,  
switch off ESP by pressing the upper half of the ESP  
switch. The ESP warning lamp v, located in the  
speedometer dial, is continuously illuminated.  
Warning!  
When the ESP warning lamp is illuminated  
continuously, the ESP is switched off.  
Adapt your speed and driving to the prevailing road  
conditions.  
With the ESP system switched off, the engine torque  
reduction feature is cancelled. Therefore, the enhanced  
vehicle stability offered by ESP is unavailable.  
P54.25-2037-26  
ESP control switch located on center console.  
To switch ESP off, press upper half of the switch.  
Adapt your speed and driving to the prevailing road  
conditions.  
A portion of the ESP system remains active, even with  
the switch in the OFF position.  
ESP warning lamp v, located in speedometer dial,  
comes on.  
If one drive wheel loses traction and begins to spin, the  
brake is applied until the wheel regains sufficient  
traction. The traction control engages at vehicle speeds  
up to approximately 24 mph (40 km/h), and switches off  
at 50 mph (80 km/h).  
To switch ESP on again, press lower half of the switch.  
ESP warning lamp v, located in speedometer dial,  
goes out.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Note:  
The ESP warning lamp, located in the speedometer dial,  
starts to flash at any vehicle speed as soon as the tires  
lose traction and the wheels begin to spin.  
Avoid spinning of one drive wheel. This may cause  
serious damage to the drive train which is not covered  
by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
To return to the enhanced vehicle stability offered by  
ESP: press lower half of the switch (the ESP warning  
lamp in the speedometer dial goes out).  
Warning!  
ESP should not be switched off during normal  
driving other than in circumstances described  
above. Disabling of the system will reduce vehicle  
stability in standard driving maneuvers.  
Important!  
If the ESP warning lamp flashes:  
during take-off, apply as little throttle as possible,  
while driving, ease up on the accelerator.  
Driving systems  
223  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
What you should know at the gas station  
What you should know at the gas station  
224  
Open flap by pushing near front (arrow). Turn fuel cap  
to the left and hold on to it until possible pressure in  
tank has been released, then remove cap. Failure to  
remove slowly could result in personal injury.  
Manual release of fuel filler flap, see page 298.  
Fuel  
To prevent fuel vapors from escaping into open air, fully  
insert filler nozzle unit. Only fill fuel tank until the filler  
nozzle unit cuts out – do not top up or overfill.  
Warning!  
Overfilling of fuel tank may result in creating  
pressure in the system which could cause a gas  
discharge such as the gas spraying back out upon  
removing the filler nozzle which could cause  
personal injury.  
Fuel supply  
Warning!  
Gasoline is highly flammable and poisonous. It  
burns violently and can cause serious injury.  
Whenever you are around gasoline, avoid inhaling  
fumes and skin contact, extinguish all smoking  
materials. Never allow sparks, flame or smoking  
materials near gasoline!  
Leaving the engine running and the fuel cap open can  
cause the “CHECK ENGINE” lamp to illuminate.  
Fuel tank capacity approx. 16.4 US gal (62.0 l).  
This includes approx. 2.1 US gal (8.0 l) reserve. Use  
premium unleaded gasoline: Posted Octane Index 91  
(Average of 96 RON/86 MON).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
• Engine oil  
• Air conditioner  
Engine oil level check, see page 112 and page 256.  
R-134a refrigerant and special PAG lubricant, see  
page 317.  
Fill quantity between upper and lower dipstick  
marking level: 2.1 US qt (2.0 l).  
• Bulbs  
Recommended engine oils, see Approved Service  
Products sheet.  
High and low beams: H7 (55 W),  
low beam: Xenon (optional)  
fog lamps: H1 (55 W),  
turn signal lamps,  
• Coolant  
For normal replenishing, use water (potable water  
quality).  
front 1156 NA (26.9/5 W/32/4 cp),  
parking and standing lamps, front: H 6W (6 W),  
side marker lamps, front: 5 W/4 cp,  
turn signal lamps, rear: 21 W/24 cp,  
stop, tail, parking and side marker lamps: 21/4 W,  
tail and parking lamp: 5 W/4 cp,  
rear fog lamp, driver’s side: 21 W/32 cp,  
backup lamps: 21 W/32 cp,  
For further information (e.g. anticorrosion/  
antifreeze), see page 317.  
• Spark plugs  
Approved spark plugs, see page 315.  
• Tire pressure  
license plate lamps: 5 W/4 cp.  
For tire pressure, refer to tire pressure label inside  
the fuel filler flap. See page 271 for further details.  
What you should know at the gas station  
225  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Check regularly and before a long trip  
Check regularly and before a long trip  
226  
1 Engine oil level  
See “Engine oil level, checking” on page 112 and  
page 256.  
2 Coolant level  
See “Coolant level” on page 257.  
3 Brake fluid  
See “Brake fluid” on page 319.  
4 Windshield washer system  
Headlamp cleaning system  
For refilling reservoir see page 259.  
Opening hood, see page 254.  
Vehicle lighting: Check function and cleanliness. For  
replacement of light bulbs, see “Exterior lamps” on  
page 280.  
Exterior lamp switch, see page 114.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Telescoping steering column –  
indicator lamp ............................ 232  
Seat belt warning lamp .............232  
Malfunction and indicator  
lamps in the  
center console ...........................233  
AIRBAG OFF  
indicator lamp ............................ 233  
Roll bar warning lamp .............. 233  
Malfunction and  
warning messages in the  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE  
(engine control unit) ................. 235  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE  
(several systems) .......................235  
BATTERY/ALTERNATOR ..........236  
ABS-SYSTEM ..............................237  
BRAKE ASSIST ...........................237  
BRAKE LINING WEAR ..............238  
BRAKE FLUID .............................238  
PARKING BRAKE .......................239  
ENGINE FAN ...............................239  
COOLANT  
(coolant level) .............................240  
Instrument cluster display  
Malfunction and  
indicator lamps in the  
instrument cluster ....................228  
On-board diagnostic system  
Check engine malfunction  
indicator lamp .............................228  
Brake warning lamp ..................229  
Supplemental restraint  
system (SRS)  
Fuel reserve and fuel cap  
placement warning ....................230  
Electronic stability program  
(ESP) — warning lamp ...............231  
BAS/ESP malfunction  
indicator lamp .............................231  
ABS malfunction  
COOLANT TEMP.  
(coolant temperature) ................241  
LIGHTING SYSTEM ....................242  
LIGHT SENSOR ...........................243  
STEER. WHEEL ADJUST. ...........243  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL ...................244  
ELEC. STABIL. PROG.  
(Electronic stability  
program) ......................................245  
REMOVE KEY .............................245  
WASHER FLUID .........................246  
TELE AID .....................................247  
indicator lamp .............................231  
Contents – Instrument cluster display  
Instruments  
227  
Instrument  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
and controls  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and indicator lamps  
228  
Malfunction and indicator lamps  
in the instrument cluster  
out of fuel), serious damage can occur to the emission  
system. Please contact your authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center immediately.  
General information:  
The Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection (SFI) control  
module monitors emission control components that  
either provide input signals to or receive output signals  
from the control module. Malfunctions resulting from  
interruptions or failure of any of these components are  
indicated by the “CHECK ENGINE” malfunction  
indicator lamp in the instrument cluster and are  
simultaneously stored in the SFI control module.  
If a bulb in the instrument cluster fails to light up  
during the bulb self-check when turning the electronic  
key in steering lock to position 2, have it checked and  
replaced if necessary.  
On-board diagnostic system  
Check engine malfunction indicator lamp  
If the “CHECK ENGINE” malfunction indicator lamp  
comes on, have the system checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
Engine malfunction indicator lamp. If the  
“CHECK ENGINE” malfunction indicator  
lamp comes on when the engine is running,  
CHECK  
ENGINE  
With some exceptions, the control module switches off  
the “CHECK ENGINE” malfunction indicator lamp if the  
condition, causing the lamp to come on, no longer exists  
during three consecutive cycles. See also page 230 for  
fuel cap placement warning.  
it indicates a malfunction of the fuel management  
system, emission control system, systems which impact  
emissions, or the fuel cap is not closed tight (check the  
fuel cap). If the “CHECK ENGINE” lamp is illuminated  
continuously and the vehicle is driving normally, you  
may still drive the vehicle, however, in all cases, we  
recommend that you have the system checked at your  
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
An on-board diagnostic connector is located in the  
passenger compartment near to the parking brake  
pedal, allowing the accurate identification of system  
malfunctions through the readout of diagnostic trouble  
codes.  
If the “CHECK ENGINE” lamp comes on continuously  
and/or the vehicle is not driving normally (e.g.  
malfunction of the fuel management system or running  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Brake warning lamp  
Warning!  
Driving with the brake warning lamp illuminated  
can result in an accident. Have your brake system  
checked immediately if the brake warning lamp  
stays on. Don’t add brake fluid before checking the  
brake system. Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir  
can result in spilling brake fluid on hot engine  
parts and the brake fluid catching fire. You can be  
seriously burned.  
BRAKE  
Except Canada  
Canada only  
When the brake warning lamp and message appear  
while the engine is running, this means:  
there is insufficient brake fluid in the reservoir  
Note:  
(engine running and parking brake released), or  
If you find that the minimum mark on the brake fluid  
reservoir is reached, have the brake system checked for  
brake pad thickness and leaks.  
the parking brake is set (engine running).  
Malfunction and indicator lamps  
229  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
     
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and indicator lamps  
230  
Supplemental restraint system (SRS) indicator lamp  
Fuel reserve and fuel cap placement warning  
The operational readiness of the airbag  
system is verified by the indicator lamp  
“SRS” in the instrument cluster when  
SRS  
turning the electronic key in steering lock to position 1  
or 2. If no malfunction is detected, the lamp will go out  
after approximately 4 seconds; after the lamp goes out,  
the system continues to monitor the components and  
circuitry of the airbag system and will indicate a  
malfunction by coming on again.  
1
N54.30-2756-21  
When the warning lamp (1) comes on after starting the  
engine, or if it comes on while driving, it indicates that  
the fuel level is down to the reserve quantity of  
approximately 2.1 gal (8 liters).  
Warning!  
In the event a malfunction of the “SRS” is indicated  
as outlined above, the “SRS” may not be  
operational. For your safety, we strongly  
recommend that you visit an authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center immediately to have the  
system checked; otherwise the “SRS” may not be  
activated when needed in an accident, which could  
result in serious or fatal injury, or it might deploy  
unexpectedly and unnecessarily which could also  
result in injury.  
The warning lamp blinks when the fuel cap is not  
closed, or a fuel system leak has been detected.  
Retighten cap and see if lamp goes out after restart and  
next OBD selfcheck.  
If the warning lamp continues to blink after closing the  
fuel cap correctly, have the fuel system checked at your  
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
Leaving the engine running and the fuel cap open can  
also cause the “CHECK ENGINE” lamp to illuminate, see  
page 228.  
See page 66 for notes on airbags, see page 65 for belt  
tensioners and page 74 for infant and child seat  
restraint.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Electronic stability program (ESP) — warning lamp  
ABS malfunction indicator lamp  
The ABS malfunction indicator lamp in the  
instrument cluster comes on with the  
electronic key in steering lock position 2 and  
should go out with the engine running.  
The yellow ESP warning lamp in the  
speedometer dial comes on with the  
electronic key in steering lock position 2.  
ABS  
It should go out with engine running.  
When the ABS malfunction indicator lamp symbol and  
warning in the instrument cluster remains illuminated  
while the engine is running, it indicates that the ABS  
has detected a malfunction and has switched off. In this  
case, the brake system functions in the usual manner,  
but without antilock assistance.  
See page 220 if the warning lamp lights up or flashes  
when the vehicle is moving.  
BAS/ESP malfunction indicator lamp  
The malfunction indicator lamp for the ESP  
is combined with that of the BAS.  
BAS  
ESP  
With the ABS malfunctioning, the BAS and ESP are also  
switched off. Both malfunction indicator lamps come on  
with the engine running.  
The yellow BAS/ESP malfunction indicator  
lamp in the instrument cluster comes on with the  
electronic key in steering lock position 2. It should go  
out with the engine running.  
If the charging voltage falls below 10 volts, the  
malfunction indicator lamp comes on and the ABS is  
switched off. When the voltage is above this value again,  
the malfunction indicator lamp should go out and the  
ABS is operational.  
If the BAS/ESP malfunction indicator lamp remains  
illuminated with the engine running, see page 216 for  
notes on the brake assist (BAS) and page 220 for notes  
on the electronic stability program (ESP).  
Have the system checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
See page 218 for notes on the antilock brake system  
(ABS).  
Malfunction and indicator lamps  
231  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
     
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and indicator lamps  
232  
Telescoping steering column – indicator lamp  
Seat belt warning lamp  
The indicator lamp in the instrument cluster  
comes on with the electronic key in steering  
lock position 2 and should go out with the  
engine running.  
With the electronic key in steering lock  
position 2, the seat belt warning lamp comes  
on and a warning sounds for approx.  
6 seconds if the driver’s seat belt is not fastened.  
If the indicator lamp does not go out after starting the  
engine, the adjustable steering column is not properly  
locked.  
For locking the adjustable telescoping steering column,  
see page 76.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Malfunction and indicator lamps in the  
center console  
Roll bar warning lamp  
The roll bar warning lamp is located in the roll bar  
switch in the center console. Roll bar switch see  
page 52.  
AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp  
With the electronic key in steering lock position 2, the  
roll bar warning lamp comes on and should go out with  
the engine running.  
The 7 indicator lamp will light up for approx.  
6 seconds when you turn the electronic key in steering  
lock to position 1 or 2.  
With the engine running and the roll bar lowered, the  
warning lamp in the roll bar switch will blink for  
approx. 15 seconds. The blinking is reminding you to  
raise the roll bar if the rear passenger seats are  
occupied.  
The 7 indicator lamp stays lit as long as a  
BabySmartTM compatible child seat is properly installed  
on the front passenger seat. It indicates that the front  
passenger airbag is switched off.  
See page 64 for BabySmartTM deactivation system.  
Warning!  
BabySmartTM is a trademark of Siemens Automotive Corp.  
If the warning lamp does not go out after starting  
the engine, or if it comes on while driving, then the  
roll bar system is not operating properly and may  
not activate in an accident. In this case, raise the  
roll bar manually (see page 53) before continuing  
to drive.  
Note:  
Have the roll bar system checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
Malfunction and indicator lamps  
233  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
     
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and warning messages  
234  
Malfunction and warning messages in the  
multifunction display  
Notes:  
Certain malfunction and warning messages are  
accompanied by an audible signal.  
Malfunction and warning messages in red are always  
Malfunction and warning messages for the following  
systems will be displayed immediately in the  
multifunction display.  
accompanied by an audible signal.  
These messages can be cleared from the instrument  
cluster by:  
Temporary messages such as “SWITCH OFF LIGHTS”  
will not be stored in the malfunction message memory.  
using the J button on the instrument cluster, or  
pressing button j, k, è or ÿ on the  
Warning!  
All messages contain important information which  
should be taken note of and, where malfunction  
indicated, addressed as soon as possible at an  
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
multifunction steering wheel.  
They are then stored in the malfunction message  
memory. See page 104.  
Failure to repair condition noted may cause  
damage not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited  
Warranty, or result in property damage or personal  
injury.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE (engine control unit)  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE (several systems)  
Line 1  
Line 2  
Line 1  
Line 2  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
This message is displayed to indicate that the  
The displays for several systems have failed. Some  
systems themselves may also have failed.  
information being relayed by the engine control unit is  
no longer complete. The coolant temperature gauge,  
tachometer, or the cruise control may have failed.  
Malfunction and warning messages  
235  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and warning messages  
BATTERY/ALTERNATOR  
236  
This message indicates a malfunction which must be  
repaired immediately.  
It may indicate that the poly-V-belt has broken. Should  
this condition occur, the poly-V-belt must be replaced  
before continuing to operate the vehicle. Otherwise, the  
engine will overheat due to an inoperative water pump  
which may result in damage to the engine.  
Do not continue to drive the vehicle with this message  
displayed.  
Doing so could result in serious engine damage that is  
not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Line 1  
Line 2  
BATTERY/ALTERNATOR  
OVERVOLTAGE  
UNDERVOLTAGE  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
CONSUMER DEFECTIVE!  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ABS-SYSTEM  
BRAKE ASSIST  
P54.30-2938-21  
Line 1  
Line 2  
Line 1  
Line 2  
ABS-SYSTEM  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
BRAKE ASSIST  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
A malfunction has been detected in the system. The  
brake system functions in the usual manner, but  
without antilock assistance.  
A malfunction has been detected in the system. The  
brake system functions in the usual manner, but  
without BAS.  
With the ABS malfunctioning, the BAS and ESP are also  
switched off.  
Have the system checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
Malfunction and warning messages  
237  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and warning messages  
BRAKE LINING WEAR  
238  
BRAKE FLUID  
Line 1  
Line 2  
Line 1  
Line 2  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
BRAKE LINING WEAR  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
BRAKE FLUID  
When this message appears during braking, it indicates  
that the brake pads are worn down.  
Warning!  
Driving with this message displayed can result in  
an accident. Have your brake system checked  
immediately. Don’t add brake fluid before checking  
the brake system. Overfilling the brake fluid  
reservoir can result in spilling brake fluid on hot  
engine parts and the brake fluid catching fire. You  
can be seriously burned.  
Have the brake system checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
PARKING BRAKE  
ENGINE FAN  
Line 1  
Line 2  
Line 1  
Line 2  
PARKING BRAKE  
RELEASE BRAKE!  
ENGINE FAN  
VISIT WORKSHOP!1  
1
The cooling fan for the coolant is faulty. Observe coolant  
temperature gauge while driving, see page 86.  
Parking brake, see page 204.  
Malfunction and warning messages  
Instruments  
239  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
and controls  
cluster display  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and warning messages  
COOLANT (coolant level)  
240  
The low engine coolant level warning should not be  
ignored. Extended driving with the symbol displayed  
may cause serious engine damage not covered by the  
Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
In cases of major or frequent minor coolant loss, have  
the cooling system checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
Notes:  
Do not drive without coolant in the cooling system. The  
engine will overheat causing major engine damage.  
Line 1  
Line 2  
Monitor the coolant temperature gauge while driving.  
See page 257 for instructions on adding coolant.  
COOLANT  
CHECK LEVEL!  
When this message appears while driving, the coolant  
level has dropped below the required level. If no leaks  
are noticeable and the engine temperature does not  
increase, continue to drive to the nearest service station  
and have coolant added to the coolant system.  
Warning!  
Do not spill antifreeze on hot engine parts.  
Antifreeze contains ethylene glycol which may  
burn if it comes into contact with hot engine parts.  
You can be seriously burned.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
COOLANT TEMP. (coolant temperature)  
During severe operating conditions and stop-and-go city  
traffic, the coolant temperature may rise close to the red  
marking.  
The engine should not be operated with the coolant  
temperature in the red zone. Doing so may cause  
serious engine damage which is not covered by the  
Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Warning!  
Driving when your engine is badly overheated can  
cause some fluids which may have leaked into the  
engine compartment to catch fire. You could be  
seriously burned.  
Line 1  
Line 2  
COOLANT TEMP.  
VISIT WORKSHOP!1  
Steam from an overheated engine can cause serious  
burns and can occur just by opening the engine  
hood. Stay away from the engine if you see or hear  
steam coming from it.  
1
Observe coolant temperature gauge, see page 86.  
Check coolant level, see page 257.  
This may indicate that the poly-V-belt has broken. Should this  
condition occur, the poly-V-belt must be replaced before continuing  
to operate the vehicle. Otherwise, the engine will overheat due to  
an inoperative water pump which may result in damage to the  
engine. Do not continue to drive the vehicle with this message  
displayed. Doing so could result in serious engine damage that is  
not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Turn off the engine, get out of the vehicle and do  
not stand near the vehicle until it cools down.  
Malfunction and warning messages  
241  
Instruments  
Operation  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
and controls  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and warning messages  
LIGHTING SYSTEM  
242  
When the message appears after starting the engine, or  
if it comes on while driving, this indicates a failure in  
the parking lamp, taillamp, stop lamp, or low beam  
headlamp. See page 280 for instructions on replacing  
bulbs.  
If an exterior lamp fails, the message will appear only  
when that lamp is switched on.  
If a brake lamp fails, the message will appear when  
applying the brake and stays on until the engine is  
turned off.  
Line 1  
Line 2  
Note:  
LAMP DEFECTIVE  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE  
CHECK LAMPS!  
If additional lighting is installed (e.g. auxiliary  
headlamps etc.) be certain to connect into the fuse  
before the failure indicator monitoring unit order to  
avoid damaging the system.  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
LIGHT SENSOR  
STEER. WHEEL ADJUST.  
With the electronic key removed and the driver’s door  
open, a warning sounds and the message “SWITCH OFF  
LIGHTS!” appears in the multifunction indicator if the  
vehicle’s exterior lamps (except standing lamps) are not  
switched off.  
Line 1  
Line 2  
STEER. WHEEL ADJUST.  
For locking the adjustable telescoping steering column,  
see page 76.  
Malfunction and warning messages  
243  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and warning messages  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL  
244  
3
4
There is a risk of damaging the engine or catalytic converter. The  
engine oil level must be checked immediately. See Engine oil level  
indicator on page 112.  
The engine oil level has dropped to a critical level.  
Check the engine oil level immediately. See Engine oil level  
indicator on page 112 and check the engine for visible leakage (loss  
of oil).  
5
6
The measuring system is malfunctioning.  
It may be that there is water in the engine oil. Have the engine oil  
checked.  
Line 1  
Line 2  
When the “ENGINE OIL LEVEL – CHECK LEVEL”  
message appears while the engine is running and at  
operating temperature, the engine oil level has dropped  
to approximately the minimum mark on the dipstick.  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL  
ENGINE OIL SENSOR  
ENGINE OIL  
CHECK LEVEL!1  
STOP, ENGINE OFF!2  
REDUCE OIL LEVEL!3  
VISIT WORKSHOP!4  
VISIT WORKSHOP!5  
VISIT WORKSHOP!6  
When this occurs, the warning will first come on  
intermittently and then stay on if the oil level drops  
further.  
If no oil leaks are noted, continue to drive to the nearest  
service station where the engine oil should be topped to  
the “full” mark on the dipstick with an approved oil.  
The engine oil level warnings should not be ignored.  
Extended driving with the symbol displayed could  
result in serious engine damage that is not covered by  
the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
1
2
The engine oil level must be checked immediately. See Engine oil  
level indicator on page 112  
There is no oil in the engine. There is a danger of engine damage.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ELEC. STABIL. PROG.  
REMOVE KEY  
(Electronic stability program)  
P54.30-3573-21  
Line 1  
Line 2  
Line 1  
Line 2  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE  
ELEC. STABIL. PROG.  
VISIT WORKSHOP!  
REMOVE KEY!  
VISIT WORKSHOP!1, 2, 3  
This message plus an audible alarm indicate that the  
electronic key is in steering lock position 0 or 1, and the  
driver’s door is open.  
1
A malfunction has been detected in the system. Pressing the  
accelerator pedal will require greater effort. Only partial engine  
output will be available.  
2
3
This message may be displayed if the power supply was  
interrupted (battery disconnected or empty).  
Synchronize ESP. See page 221  
Malfunction and warning messages  
245  
Instruments  
Operation  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
and controls  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Malfunction and warning messages  
WASHER FLUID  
246  
When this message appears while the engine is  
running, the level of the reservoir has dropped to  
approx. 1/3 of the total volume. The reservoir should be  
refilled with the prescribed mixture of MB Windshield  
Washer Concentrate “S” and water or the Concentrate  
and commercially available premixed windshield  
washer solvent/antifreeze, depending on ambient  
temperature, at the next opportunity. The reservoir for  
the windshield and headlamp washer systems is located  
in the engine compartment.  
See windshield washer system on page 259 for  
instructions on adding washer fluid.  
Line 1  
Line 2  
WASHER FLUID  
CHECK LEVEL!  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TELE AID  
Line 1  
Line 2  
TELE AID  
VISIT WORKSHOP!1  
1
When this message appears, a malfunction has been detected in  
the Tele Aid system. In some cases it may not be possible to initiate  
an Emergency, Roadside Assistance or Information call.  
See page 182 for notes on the Tele Aid.  
If a malfunction is indicated as outlined above, have the  
system checked at the nearest Mercedes-Benz Center as  
soon as possible.  
Malfunction and warning messages  
247  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
 
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windshield and headlamp  
washer fluid mixing ratio ........259  
Spare wheel, vehicle tools,  
storage compartment ...............260  
Vehicle jack .................................... 261  
Adjusting headlamp aim ...............285  
Changing batteries in  
the electronic main key ...........288  
Synchronizing  
Practical hints  
First aid kit .....................................250  
Shelf below rear window ..............250  
Stowing things in  
remote control ...........................290  
the vehicle ..................................250  
Luggage cover .................................250  
Fuses ................................................252  
Hood .................................................254  
Checking engine oil level .............256  
Automatic transmission  
fluid level ...................................257  
Coolant level ...................................257  
Adding coolant ...........................258  
Windshield washer / headlamp  
cleaning system .........................259  
Wheels ............................................262 Raising soft top manually .............291  
Tire replacement .......................262 Antenna ...........................................298  
Rotating wheels .........................263 Manual release for  
fuel filler flap .............................298  
Trunk lamp .....................................299  
Replacing wiper  
Spare wheel ....................................264  
Changing wheels ...........................266  
Tire inflation pressure ..................271  
Battery ............................................. 272  
Jump starting ..................................274  
Towing the vehicle .........................276  
Exterior lamps ............................... 280  
Headlamp assembly .................. 281  
Taillamp assemblies ..................283  
blade insert ................................299  
Contents – Practical hints  
249  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
First aid kit  
250  
First aid kit  
Luggage cover  
The first aid kit is stored in the left trunk well.  
Shelf below rear window  
Warning!  
The shelf below the rear window should not be  
used to carry objects. This will avoid such objects  
from being thrown about and injuring vehicle  
occupants during an accident or sudden maneuver.  
The trunk is the preferred place to carry objects.  
Stowing things in the vehicle  
Warning!  
1 Handle  
2 Holder  
To help avoid personal injury during a collision or  
sudden maneuver, exercise care when stowing  
things. Put luggage or cargo in the trunk if  
possible. Do not pile luggage or cargo higher than  
the seat backs. Do not place anything on the shelf  
below the rear window.  
To close compartment:  
Pull out on handle (1) to the stop and guide luggage  
cover into left and right holders (2).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Important!  
To prevent damage to soft top or luggage/cargo when  
lowering the roof:  
load trunk only to the height of the luggage cover,  
do not permit luggage/cargo to raise the closed  
luggage cover,  
do not load anything on top of the luggage cover,  
do not operate the luggage cover with the soft top  
lowered. Doing so will result in damage to the  
luggage cover or the soft top.  
P65.10-2007-26  
Note:  
To open compartment:  
Opening and closing of the soft top can only be done  
with the luggage cover and trunk lid closed.  
Press button (arrow). Unhook luggage cover from  
holders (2) and guide luggage cover with handle (1) into  
storage compartment until handle (1) locks in place.  
Luggage cover  
251  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Fuses  
252  
Fuses  
Fuse box in engine compartment  
Before replacing a blown fuse, determine the cause of  
the short circuit.  
Spare fuses are supplied inside the main fuse box (1).  
Observe amperage and color of fuse.  
A special fuse puller is supplied with the vehicle tools.  
1
Always use a new fuse for replacement. Never attempt to  
repair or bridge a blown fuse.  
A fuse chart can be found inside the corresponding fuse  
box cover.  
1 Main fuse box in engine compartment  
To gain access to the main fuse box (1), press clamp  
(arrow), lift the fuse box cover up and remove it.  
To close the main fuse box, engage back end of cover  
and let front end snap into place.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Auxiliary fuse box below the trunk floor  
Auxiliary fuse box in the dashboard  
2
P
2 Auxiliary fuse box below the trunk floor.  
3 Auxiliary fuse box to left of exterior lamp switch.  
To gain access, lift trunk floor.  
To gain access, open door, pry off cover (3) and  
remove.  
Fuses  
253  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Engine compartment  
Hood  
254  
The engine is equipped with a transistorized  
ignition system. Because of the high voltage it is  
dangerous to touch any components (ignition coils,  
spark plug sockets, diagnostic socket) of the  
ignition system  
Warning!  
To help prevent personal injury, stay clear of  
moving parts when the hood is open and the engine  
is running. Be sure the hood is properly closed  
before driving. When closing hood, use extreme  
caution not to catch hands or fingers.  
• with the engine running,  
• while starting the engine,  
• if ignition is “on” and the engine is turned  
manually.  
The radiator fan may continue to run for  
approximately 30 seconds or even restart after the  
engine has been turned off. Stay clear from fan  
blades.  
If you see flames, steam or smoke coming from the  
engine compartment, or if the coolant temperature  
gauge indicates that the engine is overheated, do  
not open the hood. Move away from vehicle and do  
not open the hood until the engine has cooled. If  
necessary, call a fire department.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3
3
1
2
P88.40-2017-26  
P88.40-2025-26  
To open:  
Pull handle (2) to its stop out of radiator grill and open  
hood (do not pull up on handle).  
To unlock the hood, pull release lever (1) under the  
driver’s side of the instrument panel. At the same time a  
handle will extend out of the radiator grill (it may be  
necessary to lift the hood up slightly).  
To close:  
Lower hood and let it drop into lock from a height of  
approx. 1 ft. (30 cm), assisting with hands placed flat on  
edges of hood (3).  
Caution!  
To avoid hood damage, please make sure that hood is  
fully closed. If not, repeat closing procedure. Do not  
push down on hood to attempt to fully close it.  
To avoid damage to the windshield wiper or hood, open  
the hood only with wiper in the parked position.  
Engine compartment  
255  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Engine compartment  
256  
Checking engine oil level (CLK 320 shown)  
Wipe oil dipstick clean prior to checking the engine oil  
level. Fully insert dipstick in tube, and remove after  
three seconds to obtain accurate reading.  
M e r c e d e s - B e n z  
Oil level must be between the  
lower (min) and upper (max) mark of  
the dipstick.  
2
M e r c e d e s - B e n z  
1
Fill quantity between upper and lower dipstick marking  
level is approximately 2.1 US qt (2.0 l).  
Do not overfill the engine. Excessive oil must be drained  
or siphoned. It could cause damage to engine and  
catalytic converter not covered by the Mercedes-Benz  
Limited Warranty.  
1 Oil dipstick  
See malfunction and warning messages on page 234 if  
an engine oil level display appears on the multifunction  
display when the engine is running.  
2 Oil filler cap  
To check the engine oil level, park vehicle on level  
ground, with engine at normal operational temperature.  
Note:  
Check engine oil level approximately 5 minutes after  
stopping the engine, allowing for the oil to return to the  
oil pan.  
See page 112 for engine oil level indicator.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Automatic transmission fluid level  
Coolant level  
The transmission has a permanent fill of automatic  
transmission fluid.  
Regular automatic transmission fluid level checks and  
changes are not required. For this reason the dipstick is  
omitted.  
If you notice fluid leaks or gear shifting malfunctions,  
have your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center check the  
transmission fluid level.  
P20.30-2032-26  
To check the coolant level, the vehicle must be parked  
on level ground and the engine stopped.  
Check coolant level only when coolant is cold.  
The coolant level should reach the black top part of the  
reservoir.  
Engine compartment  
257  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Engine compartment  
Adding coolant  
258  
• Using a rag, slowly open cap approximately  
1/2 turn to relieve excess pressure. If opened  
immediately, scalding hot fluid and steam will  
be blown out under pressure.  
If coolant has to be added, a 50/50 mixture of water and  
MB anticorrosion/antifreeze should be added.  
The drain plugs for the cooling system are located on  
the right side of the engine block and at the bottom of  
the radiator.  
• Do not spill antifreeze on hot engine parts.  
Antifreeze contains ethylene glycol which may  
burn if it comes into contact with hot engine  
parts.  
Anticorrosion/antifreeze mixture, see page 322.  
Warning!  
In order to avoid possible serious burns or injury:  
• Use extreme caution when opening the hood if  
there are any signs of steam or coolant leaking  
from the cooling system, or if the coolant  
temperature gauge indicates that the coolant is  
overheated.  
• Do not remove pressure cap on coolant  
reservoir if engine temperature is above 194°F  
(90°C). Allow engine to cool down before  
removing cap. The coolant reservoir contains  
hot fluid and is under pressure.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Windshield washer/headlamp cleaning system  
Warning!  
Washer solvent/antifreeze is highly flammable. Do  
not spill washer solvent/antifreeze on hot engine  
parts, because it may burn. You can be seriously  
burned.  
Windshield and headlamp washer  
fluid mixing ratio  
1
For temperatures above freezing:  
MB Windshield Washer Concentrate “S” and water.  
1 part “S” to 100 parts water  
(40 ml “S” to 1 gallon water).  
P82.35-2017-26  
1 Windshield washer/headlamp cleaning system fluid  
For temperature below freezing:  
reservoir  
MB Windshield Washer Concentrate “S” and  
commercially available premixed windshield washer  
solvent/antifreeze.  
Capacity approx. 7.4 US qt (7.0 l).  
The reservoir should be refilled with MB Windshield  
washer concentrate and water (or commercially  
available premixed windshield washer solvent/  
antifreeze, depending on ambient temperatures).  
1 part “S” to 100 parts solvent  
(40 ml “S” to 1 gallon solvent).  
Engine compartment  
259  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Spare wheel, vehicle jack  
260  
Spare wheel, vehicle tools, storage compartment  
Lift trunk floor and engage handle in grip molding of  
luggage cover.  
To remove spare tire:  
Turn luggage bowl counterclockwise and remove.  
To store spare tire:  
Place spare tire in wheel well and secure it with luggage  
bowl. Turn luggage bowl clockwise to its stop.  
Note:  
Always lower trunk floor before closing trunk lid.  
1 Trunk floor  
2 Handle  
3 Luggage bowl  
4 Vehicle tools  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Vehicle jack  
Warning!  
The jack is designed exclusively for jacking up the  
vehicle at the jack tubes built into either side of the  
vehicle. To help avoid personal injury, use the jack  
only to lift the vehicle during a wheel change.  
Never get beneath the vehicle while it is supported  
by the jack. Keep hands and feet away from the area  
under the lifted vehicle. Always firmly set parking  
brake and block wheels before raising vehicle with  
jack.  
2
Do not disengage parking brake while the vehicle is  
raised. Be certain that the jack is always vertical  
when in use, especially on hills. Always try to use  
the jack on level surface. Be sure that the jack arm  
is fully inserted in the jack tube. Always lower the  
vehicle onto sufficient capacity jackstands before  
working under the vehicle.  
1
P40.10-2027-26  
1 Jack arm  
2 Jack base  
See illustration for proper storage of jack.  
Before storing the jack on the felt in the spare wheel  
well, the jack arm must be lowered almost to the base of  
the jack.  
Spare wheel, vehicle jack  
261  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tires, Wheels  
262  
Wheels  
It is imperative that the wheel mounting bolts be  
fastened to a tightening torque of 80 ft.lb. (110 Nm)  
whenever wheels are mounted.  
Replace rims or tires with the same designation,  
manufacturer and type as shown on the original part.  
See your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for further  
information.  
For rim and tire specifications, refer to “Technical Data”  
(page 314).  
See your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for  
information on tested and recommended rims and tires  
for summer and winter operation. They can also offer  
advice concerning tire service and purchase.  
Warning!  
Worn, old tires can cause accidents. If the tire tread  
is badly worn, or if the tires have sustained  
damage, replace them.  
When replacing rims, use only genuine  
Tire replacement  
Mercedes-Benz wheel bolts specified for the  
particular rim type. Failure to do so can result in  
the bolts loosening and possibly an accident.  
Front tires should be replaced in sets. Rims and tires  
must be of the correct size and type. For dimensions,  
see “Technical Data” (page 314).  
We recommend that you break in new tires for approx.  
60 miles (100 km) at moderate speed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Rotating wheels  
Notes:  
CLK 430:  
Thoroughly clean the inner side of the wheels any time  
you rotate the wheels or wash the vehicle underside.  
Wheel rotation applies only when winter tires are  
mounted on all four wheels.  
The use of retread tires is not recommended. Retread  
tires may adversely affect the handling characteristics  
and safety of the vehicle.  
The wheels can be rotated according to the degree of  
tire wear while retaining the same direction of travel.  
Rotating, however, should be carried out as  
Dented or bent rims can cause tire pressure loss and  
damage to the tire beads. For this reason, check rims for  
damage at regular intervals. The rim flanges must be  
checked for wear before a tire is mounted. Remove  
burrs, if any.  
recommended by the tire manufacturer, before the  
characteristic tire wear pattern (shoulder wear on front  
wheels and tread center wear on rear wheels) becomes  
visible, as otherwise the driving properties deteriorate.  
Check and ensure proper tire inflation pressure after  
rotating the wheels. For tire inflation pressure see  
inside of fuel filler flap and also page 271.  
Important!  
Unidirectional tires must always be mounted with arrow  
on tire sidewall pointing in direction of vehicle forward  
movement.  
Tires, Wheels  
263  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tires, Wheels  
264  
Spare wheel  
Unidirectional tires must always be mounted with arrow  
on tire sidewall pointing in direction of vehicle forward  
movement.  
Spare wheel CLK 320  
Important!  
If the arrow on tire side wall does not point in direction  
of vehicle forward movement when using the spare  
wheel, observe the following restriction:  
The spare wheel rim is mounted with a full size tire of  
the same type as on the vehicle, and is fully functional.  
However, that spare wheel rim is weight optimized and  
has a limited service life of 12 000 miles (20 000 km)  
use before a standard wheel rim must replace it.  
Drive to the nearest tire repair facility as soon as  
possible.  
For rim and tire specifications, refer to “Technical Data”  
(page 314).  
In the case of a flat tire, you may temporarily use the  
spare wheel.  
Warning!  
Do not operate vehicle with more than one spare wheel  
mounted.  
The spare wheel rim is for temporary use only. Use  
for over a total of 12 000 miles (20 000 km)  
(aggregate of all uses) may cause wheel rim failure  
leading to an accident and possible injuries.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Spare wheel CLK 430  
Do not operate vehicle with more than one spare wheel  
mounted.  
Important!  
The spare wheel rim size is 71/2 J x 17 H 2.  
Unidirectional tires must always be mounted with arrow  
on tire sidewall pointing in direction of vehicle forward  
movement.  
The spare wheel rim is mounted with a full size tire of  
the same type as on the vehicle’s front axle, and is fully  
functional. However, that spare wheel rim is weight  
optimized and has a limited service life of 12 000 miles  
(20 000 km) use before a standard wheel rim must  
replace it.  
For rim and tire specifications, refer to “Technical Data”  
(page 314).  
Warning!  
The spare wheel rim is for temporary use only. Use  
for over a total of 12 000 miles (20 000 km)  
(aggregate of all uses) may cause wheel rim failure  
leading to an accident and possible injuries.  
If the arrow on tire side wall does not point in direction  
of vehicle forward movement when using the spare  
wheel, observe the following restriction:  
The dimensions of the spare wheel are different  
from those of the road wheels for the rear axle. As a  
result, the vehicle handling characteristics change  
when driving with a spare wheel mounted on the  
rear axle.  
Drive to the nearest tire repair facility as soon as  
possible.  
In the case of a rear axle flat tire, you may temporarily  
use the spare wheel, when observing the following  
restrictions:  
The spare wheel should only be used temporarily,  
and replaced with a regular road wheel as quick as  
possible.  
Do not exceed vehicle speed of 50 mph (80 km/h)  
Drive to the nearest tire repair facility to have the  
flat tire repaired or replaced as appropriate.  
Tires, Wheels  
265  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tires, Wheels  
266  
Changing wheels  
Move vehicle to a level area which is a safe distance  
from the roadway.  
Warning!  
Warning!  
The jack is designed exclusively for jacking up the  
vehicle at the jack tubes built into either side of the  
vehicle. To help avoid personal injury, use the jack  
only to lift the vehicle during a wheel change.  
Never get beneath the vehicle while it is supported  
by the jack. Keep hands and feet away from the area  
under the lifted vehicle. Always firmly set parking  
brake and block wheels before raising vehicle with  
jack.  
Before working on the vehicle, e.g. when changing  
wheels, the roll bar should be raised with the  
switch, and the electronic key be removed from the  
steering lock, to prevent possible injury.  
1. Set parking brake and turn on hazard warning  
flasher.  
2. Move selector lever to position “P” and turn off  
engine.  
Do not disengage parking brake while the vehicle is  
raised. Be certain that the jack is always vertical  
when in use, especially on hills. Always try to use  
the jack on level surface. Be sure that the jack arm  
is fully inserted in the jack tube. Always lower the  
vehicle onto sufficient capacity jackstands before  
working under the vehicle.  
3. Prevent vehicle from rolling away by blocking  
wheels with wheel chocks (not supplied with  
vehicle) or sizable wood block or stone. When  
changing a wheel on a hill, place chocks on the  
downhill side blocking both wheels of the other  
axle. On a level road, place one chock in front of and  
one behind the wheel that is diagonally opposite to  
the wheel being changed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4. Using the wrench, loosen but do not yet remove the  
wheel bolts.  
5. Remove the protective cover from the jack support  
tube opening by inserting the screwdriver (supplied  
in the tool kit) in the opening and prying it out.  
The tube openings are located directly behind the  
front wheel housings and in front of the rear wheel  
housings.  
Tires, Wheels  
267  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tires, Wheels  
268  
1
P40.10-2169-26  
P40.10-2167-26  
6. Insert jack arm fully into the tube hole up to the  
stop. Place jack on firm ground. Position the jack so  
that it is always vertical (plumb-line) as seen from  
the side (see arrow), even if the vehicle is parked on  
an incline.  
8. Unscrew upper-most wheel bolt and install  
alignment bolt (1) supplied in the tool kit. Remove  
the remaining bolts. Keep bolt threads protected  
from dirt and sand.  
9. Remove wheel. Grip wheel from the sides. Keep  
hands from beneath the wheels.  
7. Jack up the vehicle until the wheel is clear of the  
ground. Never start engine while vehicle is raised.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4
2
3
5
10. Clean contact surfaces of wheel and wheel hub.  
Install wheel on wheel hub. Insert wheel bolts and  
tighten them slightly.  
11. Lower vehicle. Remove jack and insert jack tube  
cover.  
12. Using the wrench, tighten the five bolts evenly,  
following the sequence illustrated, until all bolts are  
tight.  
To avoid paint damage, place wheel flat against hub  
and hold it there while installing first wheel bolt.  
Unscrew the alignment bolt (1) to install the last  
wheel bolt.  
Observe a tightening torque of 80 ft.lb. (110 Nm).  
13. Ensure proper tire pressure.  
Tires, Wheels  
269  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Tires, Wheels  
270  
Warning!  
Warning!  
Always replace wheel bolts that are damaged or  
rusted.  
The spare wheel rim is for temporary use only. Use  
for over a total of 12 000 miles (20 000 km)  
(aggregate of all uses) may cause wheel rim failure  
leading to an accident and possible injuries.  
Never apply oil or grease to wheel bolts.  
Damaged wheel hub threads should be repaired  
immediately.  
Notes:  
Incorrect mounting bolts or improperly tightened  
mounting bolts can cause the wheel to come off.  
This could cause an accident. Be sure to use the  
correct mounting bolts.  
Before storing the jack, the jack arm must be lowered  
almost to the base of the jack.  
For proper storage of vehicle jack see page 261.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tire inflation pressure  
Tire pressures listed for light loads are minimum values  
offering high driving comfort. Increased inflation  
pressures for heavy loads produce favorable handling  
characteristics with lighter loads and are perfectly  
permissible. The ride of the vehicle, however, will  
become somewhat harder.  
A table (see fuel filler flap) lists the tire inflation  
pressures specified for Mercedes-Benz recommended  
tires as well as for the varying operating conditions.  
Important!  
Tire temperature and pressure increase with the vehicle  
speed. Tire pressure should therefore only be checked  
and corrected on cold tires. Correct tire pressure in  
warm tires only if pressure has dropped below the  
pressure listed in the table and the respective operating  
conditions are taken into consideration.  
Tire pressure changes by approx. 1.5 psi (0.1 bar) per  
18°F (10°C) of air temperature change. Keep this in  
mind when checking tire pressure inside a garage –  
especially in the winter.  
Example:  
If garage temperature = approx. +68°F (+20°C) and  
ambient temperature = approx. +32°F (0°C) then the  
adjusted air pressure = specified air pressure +3 psi  
(+0.2 bar).  
An underinflated tire due to a slow leak (e.g. due to a  
nail in the tire) may cause damage such as tread  
separation, bulging etc.. Regular tire pressure checks  
(including the spare tire) at intervals of no more than  
14 days are therefore essential.  
Tires, Wheels  
271  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Battery  
272  
If a tire constantly loses air, it should be inspected for  
damage.  
Battery  
Warning!  
The spare tire should be checked periodically for  
condition and inflation. Spare tire will age and become  
worn over time even if never used, and thus should be  
inspected and replaced when necessary.  
Failure to follow these instructions can result in  
severe injury or death.  
Never lean over batteries while connecting, you  
might get injured.  
Warning!  
Battery fluid contains sulfuric acid. Do not allow  
this fluid to come in contact with eyes, skin or  
clothing. In case it does, immediately flush affected  
area with water and seek medical help if necessary.  
Do not overinflate tires. Overinflating tires can  
result in sudden deflation (blowout) because they  
are more likely to become punctured or damaged  
by road debris, potholes etc.. Follow recommended  
inflation pressures.  
A battery will also produce hydrogen gas, which is  
flammable and explosive. Keep flames or sparks  
away from battery, avoid improper connection of  
jumper cables, smoking etc..  
Do not overload the tires by exceeding the specified  
vehicle capacity weight (as indicated by the label  
on the driver’s door latch post). Overloading the  
tires can overheat them, possibly causing a  
blowout.  
Important!  
Battery replacement information:  
The maintenance-free battery is located in the trunk  
under the trunk floor.  
The service life of the battery is dependent on its  
condition of charge. The battery should always be kept  
sufficiently charged, in order to last an optimum length  
of time.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Therefore, we strongly recommend that you have the  
battery charge checked frequently, and corrected if  
necessary, especially if you use the vehicle less than  
approximately 200 miles (300 km) per month,  
mostly for short distance trips, or if it is not used for  
long periods of time.  
Notes:  
After reconnecting the battery also set the clock (see  
page 106) resynchronize the front seats (see page 49),  
front seat head restraints (see page 49), the express  
feature of the power windows (see page 147), and the  
electronic stability program (ESP) (see page 221).  
Only charge a battery with a battery charger after the  
battery has been disconnected from the vehicle’s  
electrical circuit.  
If the soft top is in a half open position, it also has to be  
synchronized. To do so, raise and lock soft top manually  
(see page 291).  
Always disconnect the battery negative lead first and  
connect last.  
Battery recycling  
When removing and connecting the battery, always  
make sure that all electrical consumers are off and the  
electronic key is in steering lock position 0. The battery  
and its filler caps must always be securely installed  
when the vehicle is in operation. During removal and  
installation always protect the disconnected battery  
positive (+) terminal with the cover attached to the  
battery.  
Batteries contain material that can harm the  
environment with improper disposal.  
Large 12 Volt storage batteries contain lead.  
Recycling of batteries is the preferred method of  
disposal.  
Many states require sellers of batteries to accept old  
batteries for recycling.  
While the engine is running the battery terminal clamps  
must not be loosened or detached, otherwise the  
generator and other electronic components would be  
damaged.  
Battery  
273  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Jump starting  
274  
Jump starting  
Important!  
A discharged battery can freeze at approx. +14°F  
(–10°C). In that case, it must be thawed out before  
jumper cables are used. Attempting to jump start a  
frozen battery can result in it exploding, causing  
personal injury.  
Warning!  
Failure to follow these directions will cause  
damage to the electronic components, and can lead  
to a battery explosion and severe injury or death.  
Never lean over batteries while connecting or jump  
starting, you might get injured.  
Jumper cable specifications:  
Minimum cable cross-section of 25 mm2 or approx.  
Battery fluid contains sulfuric acid. Do not allow  
this fluid to come in contact with eyes, skin or  
clothing. In case it does, immediately flush affected  
area with water, and seek medical help if  
necessary.  
2 AWG  
Maximum length of 11.5 ft. (3.5 m).  
If the battery is discharged, the engine should be started  
with jumper cables and the (12 V) battery of another  
vehicle.  
A battery will also produce hydrogen gas, which is  
flammable and very explosive. Keep flames or  
sparks away from battery, avoid improper  
connection of jumper cables, smoking etc..  
Only use 12 V battery to jump start your vehicle. Jump  
starting with more powerful battery could damage the  
vehicle’s electrical systems, which will not be covered  
by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Read all instructions before proceeding.  
The battery is located in the trunk under the trunk floor.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Proceed as follows:  
Important!  
1. Position the vehicle with the charged battery so that  
the jumper cables will reach, but never let the  
vehicles touch. Make sure the jumper cables do not  
have loose or missing insulation.  
5. Start engine of the vehicle with the charged battery  
and run at high idle. Make sure the cables are not  
on or near pulleys, fans, or other parts that move  
when the engine is started. Allow the discharged  
battery to charge for a few minutes. Start engine of  
the disabled vehicle in the usual manner.  
2. On both vehicles:  
Turn off engine and all lights and accessories,  
6. After the engine has started, remove jumper cables  
by exactly reversing the above installation  
sequence, starting with the last connection made  
first. When removing each clamp, make sure that it  
does not touch any other metal while the other end  
is still attached.  
except hazard warning flashers or work lights.  
Apply parking brake and shift selector lever to  
position “P”.  
Important!  
3. Clamp one end of the first jumper cable to the  
positive (+) under hood terminal of the discharged  
battery and the other end to the positive (+) terminal  
of the charged battery. Make sure the cable clamps  
do not touch any other metal parts.  
Notes:  
If engine does not run after several unsuccessful  
starting attempts, have it checked at the nearest  
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Excessive unburned fuel may damage the catalytic  
converter.  
4. Clamp one end of the second jumper cable to the  
grounded negative (–) terminal of the charged  
battery and the final connection to the negative (–)  
terminal (2) of the discharged battery.  
Jump starting  
275  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Towing  
276  
Towing the vehicle  
Important!  
When towing the vehicle, please, note the following:  
Prior to towing the vehicle with all wheels on the  
ground, make certain that the electronic key is in  
steering lock position 2.  
With the automatic central locking activated and the  
electronic key in steering lock position 2, the vehicle  
doors lock if the left front wheel as well as the right rear  
wheel are turning at vehicle speeds of approx. 9 mph  
(15 km/h) or more.  
If the electronic key is left in the steering lock  
position 0 for an extended period of time, it can no  
longer be turned in the lock. In this case, the  
steering is locked. To unlock, remove electronic key  
from steering lock and reinsert.  
To prevent the vehicle door locks from locking,  
deactivate the automatic central locking, see page 37.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
P88.20-2027-26  
P88.20-2026-26  
The rear towing eye is located at the right, below the  
bumper. The front towing eye is located on the  
passenger side behind a cover in the bumper panel.  
CLK 430:  
Cover removal:  
Hold left and right end of grille and pull out.  
Cover installation:  
CLK 320:  
Engage left and right end of grille and press in securely.  
Cover removal:  
Insert finger in recess of cover and pull cover out.  
Cover installation:  
Engage cover at bottom and press in top securely.  
Towing  
277  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Towing  
278  
We recommend that the vehicle be transported using  
flat bed equipment. This method is preferable to other  
types of towing.  
Note:  
To signal turns while being towed with hazard warning  
flasher in use, turn electronic key in steering lock to  
position 2 and activate combination switch for left or  
right turn signal in usual manner – only the selected  
turn signal will operate.  
The vehicle may be towed with all wheels on the ground  
and the selector lever in position “N” for distances up to  
30 miles (50 km) and at a speed not to exceed 30 mph  
(50 km/h). The electronic key must be in steering lock  
position 2.  
Upon canceling the turn signal, the hazard warning  
flasher will operate again.  
To be certain to avoid a possibility of damage to the  
transmission, however, we recommend the drive shaft  
be disconnected at the rear axle drive flange for any  
towing beyond a short tow to a nearby garage.  
Caution!  
If the vehicle is towed with the front axle raised, the  
engine must be shut off (electronic key in steering lock  
position 0 or 1). Otherwise, the ESP will immediately be  
engaged and will apply the rear wheel brakes. Switch off  
the tow-away alarm (see page 44) as well as the ESP (see  
page 222).  
Do not tow with sling-type equipment. Towing with  
sling-type equipment over bumpy roads will damage  
radiator and supports.  
Use wheel lift, dolly, or flat bed equipment, with  
electronic key in steering lock turned to position 0.  
Warning!  
With the engine not running, there is no power  
assistance for the braking and steering systems. In  
this case, it is important to keep in mind that a  
considerably higher degree of effort is necessary to  
brake and steer the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Transmission selector lever, manually unlocking  
To do so, insert a pin (1), e.g. ball point pen, into the  
covered opening below the position “D” of the shift  
pattern. While pushing the pin down, move selector  
lever from position “P”.  
After removal of the pin from the opening, the cover will  
not close fully. Only after moving the selector lever to  
positions “D+” and “D–” does the cover return to its  
closed position.  
In the case of power failure the transmission selector  
lever can be manually unlocked, e.g. to tow the vehicle.  
Towing  
279  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Exterior lamps  
280  
Exterior lamps  
Notes:  
To prevent a possible electrical short circuit, switch off  
lamp prior to replacing a bulb.  
Headlamp adjustment  
When replacing bulbs, install only 12 volt bulbs with  
the specified watt rating.  
Correct headlamp adjustment is extremely important.  
Check and readjust headlamps at regular intervals and  
when a bulb has been replaced.  
When replacing halogen bulbs do not touch glass  
portion of bulb with bare hands. Use plain paper or a  
clean cloth.  
For adjusting headlamp aim see page 285.  
Replacing bulbs  
Warning!  
Warning!  
Because of high voltage in Xenon lamps, it is  
dangerous to replace the bulb or repair the lamp  
and its components. We recommend that you have  
such work done by a qualified technician.  
Bulbs and bulb holders can be very hot. Allow the  
lamp to cool down before changing a bulb.  
Halogen lamps contain pressurized gas. A bulb can  
explode if you:  
• touch or move it when hot,  
• drop the bulb,  
• scratch the bulb.  
Wear eye and hand protection.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Headlamp assembly (Halogen)  
Headlamp assembly (Xenon)  
4
4
1
1
6
6
5
5
7
7
2
2
3
3
P82.10-2394-26  
P82.10-2395-26  
1 Headlamp vertical adjustment screw  
4 Bulb socket for turn signal lamp  
2 Cover for low beam headlamp  
5 Electrical connector for low beam headlamp bulb  
6 Electrical connector for high beam headlamp bulb  
7 Bulb socket for parking and standing lamp  
3 Cover for high beam headlamp, parking and  
standing lamp  
Exterior lamps  
281  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Exterior lamps  
282  
Bulbs for low or high beam  
H7 (55 W)  
Turn signal lamp  
1156 NA (26.9/5 W/32/4 cp bulb)  
Open hood.  
Open hood.  
Rotate cover (2 or 3) counterclockwise and remove. Pull  
off electrical connector (5 or 6). Unhook clamping ring  
and remove bulb.  
Twist bulb socket (4) counterclockwise and pull out.  
Push bulb into socket, turn counterclockwise and  
remove.  
Insert new bulb (seating properly in cutouts of bulb  
socket), mount clamping ring. Reinstall and push  
electrical connector on securely.  
Insert new bulb in socket, push in and twist clockwise.  
Reinstall bulb socket. Reinstall lamp assembly until  
properly seated.  
Reinstall cover (2 or 3).  
Parking and standing lamp  
H 6W (6 W bulb)  
Xenon (optional)  
Bulb for low beam  
Open hood.  
Rotate cover (3) counterclockwise and remove.  
Warning!  
Twist bulb socket (7) counterclockwise and pull out.  
Push bulb into socket, turn counterclockwise and  
remove.  
Because of high voltage in Xenon lamps, it is  
dangerous to replace the bulb or repair the lamp  
and its components. We recommend that you have  
such work done by a qualified technician.  
Insert new bulb in socket, push in and twist clockwise.  
Reinstall bulb socket. Reinstall lamp assembly until  
properly seated.  
Reinstall cover (3).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Taillamp assemblies  
4
1
3
5
2
P82.10-2080-26  
P82.10-2083-26  
4 Driver’s side:  
Open trunk lid.  
Rear fog lamp (21 W/32 cp bulb)  
Swing cover aside (bulbs 1, 2 and 3).  
5 Backup lamp (21 W/32 cp bulb)  
1 Turn signal lamp (21 W/24 cp bulb)  
Twist bulb socket counterclockwise and pull out. Push  
bulb into socket, turn counterclockwise and remove.  
2 Stop, tail, parking, and side marker lamp  
(21/4 W bulb)  
Insert new bulb in socket, push in and twist clockwise.  
Reinstall bulb socket. Close cover (bulbs 1, 2 and 3).  
3 Tail and parking lamp (5 W/4 cp bulb)  
Exterior lamps  
283  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Exterior lamps  
284  
Side marker lamp, front (5 W/4 cp bulb)  
Carefully slide lamp towards front (arrow), and remove  
back and first.  
Twist bulb socket counterclockwise and pull out. Push  
bulb socket, turn counterclockwise and remove.  
Insert new bulb in socket, push in and twist clockwise.  
Reinstall bulb socket, push in and twist clockwise.  
To reinstall lamp, set front end of lamp in bumper and  
let back end snap into place.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
High mounted stop lamp,  
Adjusting headlamp aim  
Additional turn signals on the exterior mirror  
Correct headlamp adjustment is extremely important.  
To check and readjust a headlamp, follow steps 1  
through 5.  
The high mounted stop lamp (3rd brake lamp), and the  
additional turn signals on the exterior mirrors are  
equipped with LEDs.  
Please note:  
Have the system checked at an authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center if a fault or defect occurs.  
Low beam adjustments simultaneously aim the high  
beam.  
Vehicle should have a normal trunk load.  
1. Park vehicle on level surface approximately 25 ft.  
(7.6 m) from a vertical test screen or wall. The  
centerline of the vehicle must be at a 90° angle to  
the test screen.  
Exterior lamps  
285  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Exterior lamps  
286  
10  
N82.10-2396-26  
2. (Low beams on):  
3. (Low beams off):  
Using a carpenter’s level, align and mark a vertical  
centerline (8) on the test screen using the vertex of  
the angle formed in each beam image. As a check,  
the distance between centerlines should be  
49 1/4 inches (1250 mm). If the distance does not  
check, have the system verified at an authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Measure the vertical height from the floor to  
reference point (10) on high beam lens. Subtract  
approx. 2 inches (53 mm) from measurement, and  
mark a horizontal centerline (9) on the test screen at  
the resulting height from the floor. It must be at a  
90° angle to the vertical centerline.  
4. Open hood.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. Vertical headlamp aim (low beams on):  
Turn adjusting screw (1) (counterclockwise to adjust  
headlamp downward, clockwise upward) until the  
headlamps illuminate the test screen as shown. The  
vertex of the angle formed in each beam image  
should align with the vertical and horizontal  
centerlines (8 and 9).  
The left and right headlamps must be adjusted  
individually.  
Note:  
If it is not possible to obtain a proper headlamp  
adjustment, have the system checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Exterior lamps  
287  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Electronic main key  
288  
Changing batteries in the electronic main key  
2
1
3
4
P80.20-2201-26  
P80.35-2029-26  
1 Transmit buttons  
Changing batteries  
2 Lamp for battery check and function control  
Move locking tab (3) in direction of right arrow and  
remove mechanical key (4, left arrow).  
Checking batteries  
If one of the transmit buttons (1) is pressed, the battery  
check lamp (2) lights up briefly – indicating that the  
batteries are in order.  
Change batteries if the battery check lamp (2) does not  
light up briefly.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7
8
5
4
6
P80.35-2025-26  
P80.35-2027-26  
Insert mechanical key (4) in side opening (5) to open  
latch. Press briefly (do not use mechanical key as lever)  
to release battery compartment.  
Change batteries (7), inserting new ones under contact  
spring (8) with plus (+) side facing up.  
Return battery compartment into housing until locked  
in place and slide mechanical key back into electronic  
main key.  
Remove mechanical key from side opening.  
Carefully remove battery compartment in direction of  
arrow (6).  
Electronic main key  
289  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Electronic main key  
Important!  
290  
Synchronizing remote control  
Batteries contain materials that can harm the  
environment if disposed of improperly. Recycling of  
batteries is the preferred method of disposal. For  
disposal, please follow manufacturer’s recommendation  
on battery package.  
The remote control may have to be resynchronized, if  
the vehicle cannot be locked or unlocked.  
To synchronize insert electronic key in steering lock.  
The remote control should once again be operational.  
Replacement Battery:  
Lithium, type CR 2025 or equivalent.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Raising soft top manually  
Important!  
In case of malfunction, the power soft top can also be  
raised manually. This procedure should be performed  
with great care by two persons.  
Ensure that the trunk lid is closed while raising the soft  
top manually. Otherwise there is the possibility of  
contact between the trunk lid and the soft top  
compartment cover.  
We recommend to take off your watch or other jewelry to  
prevent personal injury.  
Warning!  
A combination open-end/hex-socket wrench in the  
vehicle tool kit is required for this job.  
Do not place your hands near the roll bar, soft top  
frame, upper windshield area or soft top storage  
compartment or between the soft top rods while the  
soft top is being raised and locked.  
1. Engage parking brake.  
2. Lower windows and open doors.  
3. Lower roll bar with roll bar switch.  
Note:  
Serious personal injury may occur.  
If the roll bar cannot be lowered, carefully guide the  
soft top across the roll bar. Lift the rear window over  
the roll bar.  
4. For safety reasons, remove electronic key from  
steering lock.  
Emergency operation of soft top  
291  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Emergency operation of soft top  
292  
1
P65.10-2009-26  
P77.30-2031-26  
5. Unlock soft top storage compartment:  
6. Place open-end wrench (1) (supplied in vehicle tool  
kit) on bolt between backrest and soft top  
compartment cover. Turn wrench (1) in direction of  
arrow to its stop and remove.  
Open trunk lid with mechanical key and lift  
protection cover.  
Using screwdriver (supplied in vehicle tool kit), turn  
screw two turns counterclockwise to the stop.  
Close trunk lid.  
Important!  
Do not place mechanical key inside trunk, since trunk is  
locked again when closing the lid.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2
4
3
P77.30-2034-26  
P77.30-2029-26  
7. Open soft top compartment cover (2) and place in  
upright position.  
8. Move soft top toward windshield header (arrow).  
Warning!  
Place hands from below on upper section of soft  
top (3) and pull hard to move soft top (4) out of its  
storage compartment.  
Do not place your hands in areas marked X.  
Serious personal injury may occur.  
Emergency operation of soft top  
293  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Emergency operation of soft top  
294  
6
4
5
2
1
P77.30-2030-26  
P77.30-2033-26  
9. Do not place soft top frame (5) onto windshield  
header.  
12. Lock soft top storage compartment:  
Place open-end wrench (1) on bolt between backrest  
and soft top compartment cover. Turn wrench (1) in  
direction of arrow to its stop and remove.  
10. Place rear window section of soft top (6) in its  
vertical position.  
11. Close soft top compartment cover (2) by placing  
hands near edges (arrows). The soft top  
compartment cover must lock in the first notch of  
compartment cover catch.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6
P77.30-2032-26  
13. Lower rear window section of soft top (6).  
15. Insert hex-socket wrench (7) to lock the soft top bow.  
14. Open trunk lid with mechanical key and carefully  
guide luggage cover into its storage compartment.  
Press soft top bow down onto soft top compartment  
cover.  
Insert and turn wrench in direction of arrow (8) to  
lock soft top bow.  
Emergency operation of soft top  
295  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Emergency operation of soft top  
296  
10  
9
P65.10-2009-26  
16. Using screwdriver (supplied in vehicle tool kit), turn  
screw clockwise to the stop.  
18. Press lock button (9) and fold down locking  
handle (10).  
17. Close trunk lid.  
Important!  
Do not place mechanical key inside trunk, since trunk is  
locked again when closing the lid.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
19. Turn locking handle 90° clockwise and pull soft top  
frame carefully down until it meets the windshield  
header attachment points.  
Turn locking handle counterclockwise to the stop to  
lock the soft top.  
Fold locking handle up until lock button engages.  
Note:  
Have the soft top operation checked at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible.  
Emergency operation of soft top  
297  
Instruments  
Operation  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
and controls  
cluster display  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Manual release for fuel filler flap  
Antenna  
298  
Manual release for fuel filler flap  
P80.20-2051-26  
The non-retractable antenna should be removed before  
entering an automatic car wash, to avoid damage to the  
antenna mast or vehicle paint finish.  
The manual release knob is located behind the right  
side trunk panel.  
In case the central locking system does not release the  
fuel filler flap, pull the manual release knob while  
simultaneously opening the fuel filler flap.  
Do not use tools (e.g. pliers) for the antenna mast  
removal.  
To remove:  
Unscrew antenna counterclockwise (1).  
To install:  
Carefully position antenna mast on threaded socket and  
turn clockwise (2) until hand tight.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Trunk lamp  
Replacing wiper blade insert  
For safety reasons, remove electronic key from steering  
lock before replacing the wiper blade, otherwise the  
motor can suddenly turn on and cause injury.  
Notes:  
Do not open engine hood with wiper arm folded forward.  
Do not allow the wiper arm to contact the windshield  
glass without a wiper blade inserted. The glass may be  
scratched or broken.  
Make certain that the wiper blade is properly installed.  
An improperly installed wiper blade may cause  
windshield damage.  
P82.20-2029-26  
If the trunk is to remain open for a long period of time,  
the trunk lamp can be switched off by pulling out the  
plunger in the switch (arrow). This prevents the vehicle  
battery from being discharged.  
When the trunk lid is closed, the switch will reset and  
turn on the lamp next time the lid is opened.  
Trunk lamp  
299  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Replacing wiper blade insert  
300  
1
2
3
P82.30-0333-26  
Removal:  
Installation:  
Fold wiper arm forward. Press safety tab down (1), push  
wiper blade downward (2) and remove.  
Slide (direction of arrow) wiper blade insert into  
retainer claws until tabs are engaged.  
Place wiper blade on firm support. Press down both tabs  
and slide (direction of arrow) the wiper blade insert out  
of the retainer claws.  
Insert wiper blade between tabs (3) on the wiper arm,  
and slide into end of wiper arm. Press safety tab upward  
until it locks in place.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wiper blade ................................305  
Light alloy wheels ..................... 305  
Instrument cluster ..................... 306  
Steering wheel and  
gear selector lever ..................... 306  
Cup holder ..................................306  
Seat belts .....................................306  
Headliner ....................................306  
Upholstery ..................................307  
Hard plastic trim items .............307  
Plastic and rubber parts ...........307  
Wind screen ..............................307  
Rubber weatherstrip ................307  
Soft top ........................................ 308  
Vehicle care  
Cleaning and care  
of the vehicle .............................302  
Power washer ..............................303  
Paintwork, painted body  
components .................................303  
Engine cleaning ..........................304  
Tar stains .....................................304  
Vehicle washing .........................304  
Ornamental moldings ................304  
Headlamps, taillamps,  
turn signal lenses ......................305  
Window cleaning ........................305  
Plastic and rubber parts ............305  
Contents – Vehicle care  
301  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Index  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle  
302  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle  
More frequent washings are necessary to deal with  
unfavorable conditions; for example, near the ocean, in  
industrial areas (smoke, exhaust emissions), or during  
winter operation.  
Warning!  
Many cleaning products can be hazardous. Some  
are poisonous, others are flammable. Always follow  
the instructions on the particular container.  
Always open your vehicle’s doors or windows when  
cleaning the inside.  
You should check your vehicle from time to time for  
stone chipping or other damage. Any damage should be  
repaired as soon as possible to prevent the start of  
corrosion.  
Never use fluids or solvents that are not designed  
for cleaning your vehicle.  
In doing so, do not neglect the underside of the vehicle.  
A prerequisite for a thorough check is a washing of the  
underbody followed by a thorough inspection. Damaged  
areas need to be reundercoated.  
In operation, your vehicle is subjected to varying  
external influences which, if gone unchecked, can  
attack the paintwork as well as the underbody and  
cause lasting damage.  
Your vehicle has been treated at the factory with a wax-  
base rustproofing in the body cavities which will last for  
the lifetime of the vehicle. Post-production treatment is  
neither necessary nor recommended by Mercedes-Benz  
because of the possibility of incompatibility between  
materials used in the production process and others  
applied later.  
Such damage is caused not only by extreme and varying  
climatic conditions, but also by air polution, road salt,  
tar, gravel and stone chipping. Grease and oil, fuel,  
coolant, brake fluid, bird droppings, insects, tree resins  
etc. should be removed immediately to avoid paint  
damage. Frequent washing reduces and/or eliminates  
the aggressiveness and potency of the above adverse  
influences.  
We have selected car-care products and compiled  
recommendations which are specially matched to our  
vehicles and which always reflect the latest technology.  
You can obtain Mercedes-Benz approved car-care  
products at your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Scratches, corrosive deposits, corrosion or damage due  
to negligent or incorrect care cannot always be removed  
or repaired with the car-care products recommended  
here. In such cases it is best to seek aid at your  
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Paintwork, painted body components  
Mercedes-Benz approved Paint Care should be applied  
when water drops on the paint surface do not “bead up”,  
normally in 3 to 5 months, depending on climate and  
washing detergent used.  
The following topics deal with the cleaning and care of  
your vehicle and give important “how-to” information as  
well as references to Mercedes-Benz approved car-care  
products.  
Mercedes-Benz approved Paint Cleaner should be  
applied if paint surface shows signs of dirt embedding  
(i.e. loss of gloss).  
Do not apply any of these products or wax if your  
vehicle is parked in the sun or if the hood is still hot.  
Additional information can be found in the booklet titled  
Vehicle Care Guide”.  
Use the appropriate MB-Touch-Up Stick for quick and  
provisional repairs of minor paint damage (i.e. chips  
from stones, vehicle doors etc.).  
Power washer  
When using a power washer for cleaning the vehicle  
always observe manufacturer’s operating instructions.  
Caution!  
Never use a round nozzle to power wash tires. The  
intense jet of water can result in damage to the tire.  
Always replace a damaged tire.  
Always keep the jet of water moving across the surface.  
Do not aim directly at soft top, electrical parts, electrical  
connectors, seals, or other rubber parts.  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle  
303  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle  
Engine cleaning  
304  
Vehicle washing  
Prior to cleaning the engine compartment make sure to  
protect electrical components and connectors from the  
intrusion of water and cleaning agents.  
Do not use hot water or wash your vehicle in direct  
sunlight. Use only a mild car wash detergent, such as  
Mercedes-Benz approved Car Shampoo.  
Corrosion protection, such as MB Anticorrosion Wax  
should be applied to the engine compartment after  
every engine cleaning. Before applying, all control  
linkage bushings and joints should be lubricated. The  
poly-V-belt and all pulleys should be protected from any  
wax.  
Thoroughly spray the vehicle with a diffused jet of  
water. Direct only a very weak spray towards the  
ventilation intake. Use plenty of water and rinse the  
sponge and chamois frequently.  
Rinse with clear water and thoroughly wipe dry with a  
chamois. Do not allow cleaning agents to dry on the  
finish.  
Tar stains  
In the winter, thoroughly remove all traces of road salt  
as soon as possible.  
Quickly remove tar stains before they dry and become  
more difficult to remove. A tar remover is  
recommended.  
When washing the underbody, do not forget to clean the  
inner sides of the wheels.  
Ornamental moldings  
For regular cleaning and care of very dirty chrome-  
plated parts, use a chrome cleaner.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Headlamps, taillamps, turn signal lenses  
Wiper blade  
Use a mild car wash detergent, such as Mercedes-Benz  
approved Car Shampoo, with plenty of water.  
Clean the wiper blade rubber with a clean cloth and  
detergent solution.  
To prevent scratches, never apply strong force and use  
only a soft, non-scratchy cloth when cleaning the lenses.  
Do not attempt to wipe dirty lenses with a dry cloth or  
sponge.  
Note:  
For safety reasons, remove electronic key from steering  
lock before cleaning the wiper blade, otherwise the  
wiper motor can suddenly turn on and cause injury.  
Window cleaning  
Light alloy wheels  
Use a window cleaning solution on all glass surfaces. An  
automotive glass cleaner is recommended.  
Mercedes-Benz approved Wheel Care should be used for  
regular cleaning of the light alloy wheels.  
Note:  
If possible, clean wheels once a week with Mercedes-  
Benz approved Wheel Care, using a soft bristle brush  
and a strong spray of water.  
For safety reasons, switch off wiper and remove  
electronic key from steering lock before cleaning the  
windshield, otherwise the wiper motor can suddenly  
turn on and cause injury.  
Follow instructions on container.  
Note:  
Plastic and rubber parts  
Use only acid-free cleaning materials. The acid could  
lead to corrosion.  
Do not use oil or wax on these parts.  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle  
305  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
         
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle  
Instrument cluster  
306  
Seat belts  
Use a gentle dishwashing detergent or mild detergent  
for delicate fabrics as a washing solution. Wipe with a  
cloth moistened in lukewarm solution. Do not use  
scouring agents.  
The webbing must not be treated with chemical  
cleaning agents. Use only clear, lukewarm water and  
soap. Do not dry the webbing at temperatures above  
176°F (80°C) or in direct sunlight.  
Warning!  
Steering wheel and gear selector lever  
Do not bleach or dye seat belts as this may severely  
weaken them. In a crash they may not be able to  
provide adequate protection.  
Wipe with a damp cloth and dry thoroughly or clean  
with Mercedes-Benz approved Leather Care.  
Cup holder  
Headliner  
Use a gentle dishwashing detergent or mild detergent  
for delicate fabrics as a washing solution. Wipe with a  
cloth moistened in lukewarm solution. Do not use  
scouring agents.  
Clean with soft bristle brush, or use a dry-shampoo  
cleaner in case of excessive dirt.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Upholstery  
Hard plastic trim items  
Using aftermarket seat covers or wearing clothing that  
have the tendency to give off coloring (e.g. when wet  
etc.) may cause the upholstery to become permanently  
discolored. By lining the seats with a proper  
intermediate cover, contact-discoloration will be  
prevented.  
Pour Mercedes-Benz approved Interior Care onto soft  
lint-free cloth and apply with light pressure.  
Plastic and rubber parts  
Do not use oil or wax on these parts.  
Leather Upholstery  
Wipe leather upholstery with a damp cloth and dry  
thoroughly or clean with Mercedes-Benz approved  
Leather Care. Exercise particular care when cleaning  
perforated leather as its underside should not become  
wet.  
Wind screen  
Use only water or mild detergent to clean the wind  
screen.  
Rubber weatherstrip  
MB Tex Upholstery  
Pour Mercedes-Benz approved Interior Care onto soft  
lint-free cloth and apply with light pressure.  
The door and windshield header rubber weatherstrip  
material should be cared for at regular intervals with a  
silicon-based car care product.  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle  
307  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwanlroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
         
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle  
Soft top  
308  
Notes:  
When you run the vehicle through an automatic car  
wash, never use hot-wax for conservation.  
Clean soft top with soft top raised and locked. Lower the  
soft top into the storage compartment only if the soft top  
is completely dry. If the soft top is kept in the storage  
compartment for a lengthy period, raise it and air out  
with the windows open about every 4 months.  
Depending on the operation mode of the car wash, there  
is the possibility of water drops entering the vehicle’s  
interior.  
Never use a power washer to clean the soft top, as you  
may damage the soft top material.  
Dry cleaning:  
Brush top (always from front to rear) with a soft-bristled  
brush.  
Remove bird droppings immediately. The organic acid  
damages the material and causes the soft top to leak.  
Wet cleaning:  
In general, regular spraying or cleansing with clear  
water is sufficient to keep the top clean.  
Brush the dry top. Wash with a mild detergent and an  
ample supply of lukewarm water by wiping with a soft-  
bristled brush or sponge from front to rear. Then rinse  
thoroughly with clear water.  
Wash the top only when heavily soiled.  
Light colored soft tops should be cleaned frequently to  
prevent spots and dirt from setting in, which could stain  
and discolor the soft top material permanently.  
If only parts of the top have been washed, wet the entire  
top and allow it to air-dry before lowering it into the  
storage compartment.  
Caution!  
Do not use sharp-edged instruments for the removal of  
ice and snow.  
Never use any gasoline, thinner, tar and stain removers,  
glass cleaner, or similar organic solvents to clean the  
soft top or wind screen. They will cause damage which  
is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Engine oil additives .......................319  
Air conditioner  
refrigerant ..................................319  
Brake fluid .......................................319  
Premium unleaded  
gasoline ...................................... 320  
Fuel requirements ........................ 320  
Gasoline additives ......................... 321  
Coolants .......................................... 321  
Consumer information ................. 323  
Technical data  
Spare parts service ........................ 310  
Warranty coverage ......................... 310  
Identification labels ....................... 311  
Layout of poly-V-belt drive ............ 312  
Technical data ................................ 313  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc. –  
capacities ................................... 317  
Engine oils ...................................... 319  
Contents – Technical data  
309  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Technical data  
310  
Spare parts service  
Warranty coverage  
All authorized Mercedes-Benz Centers maintain a stock  
of original spare parts required for maintenance and  
repair work. In addition, strategically located parts  
distribution centers provide quick and reliable parts  
service.  
Your vehicle is covered under the terms of the  
“warranties” printed in the Service and Warranty  
Information booklet and your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center will exchange or repair any  
defective parts originally installed on the vehicle in  
accordance with the terms of the following warranties:  
More than 300 000 different spare parts, for  
Mercedes-Benz models, are available.  
1. New vehicle limited warranty  
2. Emission system warranty  
3. Emission performance warranty  
Mercedes-Benz original spare parts are subjected to  
stringent quality inspections. Each part has been  
specifically developed, manufactured or selected for and  
adapted to Mercedes-Benz vehicles.  
4. California, Massachusetts, and Vermont emission  
control systems warranty  
Therefore, Mercedes-Benz original spare parts should  
be installed.  
Replacement parts and accessories are covered by the  
Mercedes-Benz Spare Parts and Accessories warranties,  
copies of which are available at any Mercedes-Benz  
Center.  
Important!  
The use of non-genuine parts and accessories not  
authorized by Mercedes-Benz could damage the vehicle  
which damage is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz  
Limited Warranty or compromise its durability or safety.  
Loss of Service and Warranty Information Booklet  
Should you lose your Service and Warranty Information  
booklet, have your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center  
arrange for a replacement. It will be mailed to you.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Identification labels  
1
2
1 Certification label  
2 Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
When ordering spare parts, please specify vehicle  
identification and engine numbers.  
Technical data  
311  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Technical data  
312  
Layout of poly-V-belt drive  
3
7
4
6
5
1 Automatic belt tensioner  
2 Crankshaft  
CLK 320 shown  
3 VIN, visible (lower edge of windshield)  
4 Engine number  
3 Air conditioner compressor  
4 Coolant pump  
5 Body number and paintwork number  
6 Emission control label  
5 Generator (alternator)  
6 Idler pulley  
7 Information label, California version  
7 Power steering pump  
Vacuum line routing for emission control system  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Technical data  
Model  
CLK 320 (208 465)1  
CLK 430 (208 470)1  
Engine  
112  
113  
Mode of operation  
No. of cylinders  
Bore  
4-stroke engine, gasoline injection  
4-stroke engine, gasoline injection  
6
8
3.54 in (89.90 mm)  
3.31 in (84.00 mm)  
195.2 cu.in. (3199 cm3)  
10:1  
3.54 in (89.90 mm)  
3.31 in (84.00 mm)  
260.3 cu.in. (4265 cm3)  
10:1  
Stroke  
Total piston displacement  
Compression ratio  
Output acc. to SAE J 1349  
215 hp/5700 rpm  
275 hp/5750 rpm  
(160 kW/5700 rpm)  
(205 kW/5750 rpm)  
Maximum torque acc. to SAE J 1349  
232 ft.lb/3000 rpm  
(315 Nm/3000 rpm)  
295 ft.lb/3200 rpm  
(400 Nm/3200 rpm)  
Maximum engine speed  
Firing order  
6000 rpm  
1-4-3-6-2-5  
2390 mm  
6000 rpm  
1-5-4-2-6-3-7-8  
2390 mm  
Poly-V-belt  
1
The quoted data apply only to the standard vehicle. See an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center  
for the corresponding data of all special bodies and special equipment.  
Technical data  
313  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Technical data  
314  
Rims – Tires  
Model  
CLK 320  
Model  
CLK 430  
Rims (light alloy)  
Wheel offset  
7 J x 16 H 2  
1.46 in (37 mm)  
Rims front axle  
(AMG light alloy)  
Wheel offset:  
71/2 J x 17 H 2  
1.46 in (37 mm)  
All season tires:  
Radial-ply tires  
205/55 R 16 91 H  
205/55 R 16 91 H M+S  
Rims rear axle  
(AMG light alloy)  
Wheel offset:  
81/2 J x 17 H 2  
1.18 in (30 mm)  
Winter tires:  
Radial-ply tires  
Radial-ply tires:  
summer tires, front axle  
summer tires, rear axle  
225/45 R 17 91 W1  
245/40 R 17 91 W2, 3  
Spare wheel  
Rim (light alloy)  
Wheel offset:  
7 J x 16 H 2  
1.46 in (37 mm)  
Spare wheel  
All season tire:  
Radial-ply tire  
Rim (light alloy)  
Wheel offset:  
71/2 J x 17 H 2  
1.46 in (37 mm)  
205/55 R 16 91 H  
Summer tire:  
Radial-ply tire  
225/45 R 17 91 W1  
1
2
3
Also permissible 225/45 ZR 17  
Also permissible 245/40 ZR 173  
Must not be used with snow chains.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Electrical system  
Model  
CLK 320  
CLK 430  
Generator (alternator)  
Starter motor  
Battery  
14 V/115 A  
12V/1.7 kW  
12V/100 Ah  
14 V/150 A  
12V/1.7 kW  
12V/100 Ah  
Spark plugs  
Bosch F 8 DPER  
Beru 14 FGH 8 DPUR X 2  
NGK PFR 5 R-11  
Bosch F 8 DPER  
Beru 14 FGH 8 DPUR X 2  
NGK PFR 5 R-11  
Electrode gap  
Tightening torque  
0.039 in (1.0 mm)  
15 – 22 ft.lb (20 – 30 Nm)  
0.039 in (1.0 mm)  
15 – 22 ft.lb (20 – 30 Nm)  
Weights (see certification tag)  
Trunk load max. 220 lb (100 kg)  
Technical data  
315  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Technical data  
316  
Main dimensions  
Model  
CLK 320  
CLK 430  
Overall vehicle length  
Overall vehicle width  
Overall height  
Wheel base  
180.2 in (4577 mm) 179.8 in (4567 mm)  
67.8 in (1722 mm)  
54.3 in (1380 mm)  
67.8 in (1722 mm)  
54.3 in (1380 mm)  
105.9 in (2690 mm) 105.9 in (2690 mm)  
Track, front  
59.3 in (1505 mm)  
58.0 in (1474 mm)  
59.3 in (1505 mm)  
58.6 in (1488 mm)  
Track, rear  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc. – capacities  
Vehicle components and their respective lubricants must match. Therefore use only brands tested and recommended  
by us. Please refer to the Factory Approved Service Products pamphlet, or inquire at your Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc.  
Model  
Capacity  
Engine with oil filter  
8.5 US qt (8.0 l)  
(recommended engine oils)  
Automatic transmission  
(automatic transmission fluid)  
CLK 320  
CLK 430  
8.5 US qt (8.0 l)  
9.6 US qt (9.1 l)  
Rear axle  
1.4 US qt (1.3 l)  
(Hypoid gear oil SAE 90, 85 W 90)  
Power steering  
(MB Power steering fluid)  
approx. 1.1 US qt (1.0 l)  
approx. 2.1 oz (60 g) each  
approx. 0.5 US qt (0.5 l)  
Front wheel hubs  
(high temperature roller bearing grease)  
Brake system  
(MB Brake fluid (DOT 4))  
Cooling system  
(MB Anticorrosion/antifreeze)  
CLK 320  
CLK 430  
approx. 9.5 US qt (9.0 l)  
approx. 11. 7 US qt (11.1 l)  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc. - capacities  
Instruments  
317  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
and controls  
cluster display  
       
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc. - capacities  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc.  
318  
Model  
Capacity  
Windshield washer system  
approx. 7.4 US qt (7.0 l)  
(MB Windshield washer concentrate “S” 1)  
Fuel tank  
including a reserve of  
approx. 16.4 US gal (62.0 l)  
approx. 2.1 US gal (8.0 l)  
(Premium unleaded gasoline:  
Posted Octane 91 (Avg. of 96 RON/86 MON))  
Air conditioner system  
(R-134a refrigerant and special  
PAC lubricant (Never R-12))  
1
Use MB Windshield Washer Concentrate “S” and water for temperatures above freezing or MB Windshield Washer Concentrate “S” and  
commercially available premixed windshield washer solvent/antifreeze for temperatures below freezing. Follow suggested mixing ratios, see  
page 259.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Engine oils  
Air conditioner refrigerant  
R-134a (HFC) refrigerant and special PAG lubricating oil  
is used in the air conditioner system.  
Engine oils are specifically tested for their suitability in  
our engines. Therefore, use only engine oils  
recommended by Mercedes-Benz. Information on  
recommended brands is available at your authorized  
Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Never use R-12 (CFC) or mineral-based lubricating oil,  
otherwise damage to the system will occur.  
Please follow Service Booklet recommendations for  
scheduled oil changes. Failure to do so could result in  
engine damage not covered by the Mercedes-Benz  
Limited Warranty.  
Brake fluid  
During vehicle operation, the boiling point of the brake  
fluid is continuously reduced through the absorption of  
moisture from the atmosphere. Under extremely hard  
operating conditions, this moisture content can lead to  
the formation of bubbles in the system thus reducing  
the system’s efficiency.  
Engine oil additives  
Do not blend oil additives with engine oil. They may be  
harmful to the engine operation.  
The brake fluid must therefore be replaced every two  
years, preferably in the spring.  
Damage or malfunctions resulting from blending oil  
additives are not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited  
Warranty.  
It is recommended to use only brake fluid approved by  
Mercedes-Benz. Your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center  
will provide you with additional information.  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc.  
319  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
       
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc.  
Premium unleaded gasoline  
320  
Fuel requirements  
Use only Premium unleaded meeting ASTM  
standard D 439:  
Caution!  
To maintain the engine’s durability and performance,  
premium unleaded gasoline must be used. If premium  
unleaded is not available and low octane fuel is used,  
follow these precautions:  
The octane number (posted at the pump) must be  
91 min. It is an average of both the Research (R) octane  
number and the Motor (M) octane number: [(R+M)/2].  
This is also known as ANTI-KNOCK INDEX.  
have the fuel tank filled only partially with unleaded  
regular and fill up with premium unleaded as soon  
as possible,  
Unleaded gasoline containing oxygenates such as  
Ethanol, IPA, IBA and TBA can be used provided the  
ratio of any one of these oxygenates to gasoline does not  
exceed 10%, MTBE not to exceed 15%.  
avoid full throttle driving and abrupt acceleration,  
The ratio of Methanol to gasoline must not exceed 3%  
plus additional cosolvents.  
do not exceed an engine speed of 3000 rpm, if the  
vehicle is loaded with a light load such as two  
persons and no luggage,  
Using mixtures of Ethanol and Methanol is not allowed.  
Gasohol, which contains 10% Ethanol and 90% unleaded  
gasoline, can be used.  
do not exceed 2/3 of maximum accelerator pedal  
position, if the vehicle is fully loaded or operating in  
mountainous terrain.  
These blends must also meet all other fuel requirements  
such as resistance to spark knock, boiling range, vapor  
pressure etc..  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Gasoline additives  
Coolants  
A major concern among engine manufacturers is carbon  
build up caused by gasoline. Mercedes-Benz  
The engine coolant is a mixture of water and  
anticorrosion/antifreeze, which provides:  
recommends the use of only quality gasoline containing  
additives that prevent the build up of carbon deposits.  
corrosion protection,  
freeze protection,  
After an extended period of using fuels without such  
additives, carbon deposits can build up especially on the  
intake valves and in the combustion area, leading to  
engine performance problems such as:  
boiling protection (by increasing the boiling point).  
The cooling system was filled at the factory with a  
coolant providing freeze protection to approximately  
-22°F (-30°C) and corrosion protection.  
warm-up hesitation,  
unstable idle,  
knocking/pinging,  
misfire,  
If the antifreeze mixture is effective to -22°F (-30°C), the  
boiling point of the coolant in the pressurized cooling  
system is reached at approximately 266°F (130°C).  
The coolant solution must be used year round to provide  
the necessary corrosion protection and increase in the  
boil-over protection. You should have it replaced every  
3 years.  
power loss.  
Do not blend other specific fuel additives with fuel.  
They only result in unnecessary cost, and may be  
harmful to the engine operation.  
To provide the important corrosion protection, the  
solution must be at least 45% anticorrosion/antifreeze  
(equals a freeze protection to approx. - 22°F [-30°C]). If  
you use a solution that is more than 55% anticorrosion/  
antifreeze (freeze protection to approx. - 49 °F [-45°C]),  
Damage or malfunctions resulting from poor fuel  
quality or from blending specific fuel additives are not  
covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty.  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc.  
321  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
   
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc.  
322  
the engine temperature will increase due to the lower  
heat transfer capability of the solution. Therefore, do not  
use more than this amount of anticorrosion/antifreeze.  
Before the start of the winter season (or once a year in  
the hot southern regions), you should have the  
anticorrosion/antifreeze concentration checked. The  
coolant is also regularly checked each time you bring  
your vehicle to your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center  
for service.  
If the coolant level is low, water and MB anticorrosion/  
antifreeze should be used to bring it up to the proper  
level (have cooling system checked for signs of leakage).  
The water in the cooling system must meet minimum  
requirements, which are usually satisfied by normal  
drinking water. If your are not sure about the water  
quality, consult your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
Anticorrosion/antifreeze quantity  
Model  
Approx. freeze protection  
-35°F  
(-37°C)  
-49°F (  
-45°C)  
Anticorrosion/antifreeze  
Your vehicle contains a number of aluminum parts. The  
use of aluminum components in motor vehicle engines  
necessitates that anticorrosion/antifreeze coolant used  
in such engines be specifically formulated to protect the  
aluminum parts. (Failure to use such anticorrosion/  
antifreeze coolant will result in a significantly  
shortened service life.)  
CLK 320  
CLK 430  
4.8 US qt  
(4.5 l)  
5.3 US qt  
(5.0 l)  
5.9 US qt  
(5.6 l)  
6.5 US qt  
(6.1 l)  
Therefore the following product is strongly  
recommended for use in your vehicle: Mercedes-Benz  
Anticorrosion/antifreeze agent.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Consumer information  
may depart significantly from the norm due to  
variations in driving habits, service practices and  
differences in road characteristics and climate.  
This has been prepared as required of all manufactures  
of passenger cars under Title 49, Code of U.S. Federal  
Regulations, Part 575 pursuant to the “National Traffic  
and Motor Vehicle Safety Act of 1966”.  
Traction  
The traction grades, from highest to lowest are AA, A, B,  
and C. Those grades represent the tire’s ability to stop  
on wet pavement as measured under controlled  
conditions on specified government test surfaces of  
asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor  
traction performance.  
Uniform tire quality grading  
Quality grades can be found where applicable on the  
tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum  
section width. For example:  
Warning!  
Tread wear 200 Traction AA  
Temperature A  
The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on  
straightahead braking traction tests, and does not  
include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or  
peak traction characteristics.  
All passenger vehicle tires must conform to federal  
safety requirements in addition to these grades.  
Treadwear  
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on  
the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled  
conditions on a specified government test course. For  
example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half  
(1 1/2) times as well on the government course as a tire  
graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends  
upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and  
Consumer information  
323  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Index  
cluster display  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Consumer information  
324  
Temperature  
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C,  
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of  
heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under  
controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory  
test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the  
material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life,  
and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire  
failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of  
performance which all passenger vehicle tires must  
meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard  
No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of  
performance on the laboratory test wheel than the  
minimum required by law.  
Warning!  
The temperature grade for this tire is established  
for a tire that is properly inflated and not  
overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation, or  
excessive loading, either separately or in  
combination, can cause excessive heat build up  
and possible tire failure.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Armrest, rear bench .......................................................156  
Ashtray  
Index  
A
Center console, front ................................................154  
Audio system ..................................................................127  
Anti-theft system .......................................................129  
Button and soft key operation .................................130  
Cassette mode ............................................................135  
CD changer .................................................................140  
CD mode .....................................................................139  
Operating and display elements .............................128  
Operating safety ........................................................127  
Operation .................................................................... 131  
Operation – audio and telephone ...........................127  
Radio mode ................................................................133  
Telephone operation .................................................143  
Audio systems ...................................................................93  
Cassette player ............................................................95  
CD player ......................................................................94  
Radio .............................................................................93  
Automatic central locking ..............................................37  
Automatic climate control ............................................120  
Air distribution ..........................................................124  
Air recirculation ........................................................125  
Air volume ..................................................................124  
Basic setting ...............................................................122  
Defogging windows ...................................................123  
ABS (Antilock brake system) ....................................... 218  
Malfunction indicator lamp .....................................231  
ABS-SYSTEM - malfunction  
and warning messages ............................................237  
Adjusting headlamp aim ...............................................285  
Adjusting telescoping steering column ........................ 76  
Air conditioner refrigerant ........................................... 319  
Air distribution ..............................................................124  
Air volume ......................................................................124  
Airbag deactivation system ............................................64  
Airbag OFF indicator lamp ...........................................233  
Airbags ..............................................................................66  
Alarm system ............................................................. 42, 44  
Antenna  
Removal ......................................................................298  
Anticorrosion/antifreeze .....................212, 258, 317, 322  
Antiglare night position .................................................77  
Antilock brake system (ABS) ....................................... 218  
Malfunction indicator lamp .....................................231  
Antitheft alarm system ...................................................42  
Aquaplaning ...................................................................209  
Index  
325  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
 
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Index  
326  
Defrosting ...................................................................123  
Display and controls .................................................122  
Dust filter ...................................................................126  
Economy .....................................................................123  
Rear window defroster .............................................124  
Special settings .........................................................123  
Automatic transmission ...............................................195  
Emergency operation ...............................................203  
Fluid level ...................................................................257  
Program mode selector switch ...............................202  
Selector lever position .............................................. 198  
Transmission selector lever, manually unlocking 279  
Block heater ....................................................................212  
BRAKE ASSIST - malfunction  
and warning messages ............................................ 237  
Brake assist system (BAS) ............................................216  
Malfunction indicator lamp .....................................231  
Brake fluid ..................................................... 229, 317, 319  
Capacity ......................................................................317  
BRAKE FLUID - malfunction  
and warning messages ............................................ 238  
BRAKE LINING WEAR - malfunction  
and warning messages ............................................ 238  
Brake pad wear .............................................................. 238  
Brake warning lamp ..................................................... 229  
Brake fluid low ......................................................... 229  
Brakes ................................................... 204, 206, 216, 220  
B
BabySmartTM airbag deactivation system .....................64  
Self-test .........................................................................64  
Backrest, front seat ..........................................................54  
BAS (Brake assist system) ............................................ 216  
Malfunction indicator lamp .....................................231  
Battery .............................................................................272  
Battery recycling .......................................................273  
BATTERY/ALTERNATOR - malfunction  
C
Capacities  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc. ............................... 317  
Cargo tie-down rings .....................................................156  
Catalytic converter .........................................................180  
Cellular telephone ..........................................................157  
Center console ..................................................................20  
Central locking switch ....................................................36  
and warning messages ............................................236  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Central locking system ...................................................28  
Automatic central locking .........................................37  
Choosing global or selective mode ........................... 31  
Electronic main key ....................................................25  
Electronic reserve key ................................................26  
Locking and unlocking ..............................................30  
Mechanical keys ..........................................................33  
Changing wheels ...........................................................266  
CHECK ENGINE malfunction indicator lamp ............228  
Check regularly and before a long trip ......................226  
Checking engine oil level  
COOLANT TEMP. (coolant temperature) -  
malfunction and warning messages ......................241  
Coolant temperature gauge ............................................86  
Coolants ...........................................................................321  
Anticorrosion/antifreeze quantity .........................321  
Cruise control .................................................................214  
Cup holder  
Center console, front ................................................153  
D
Daytime running lamps ................................................ 115  
Deep water  
Driving instructions .................................................212  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE (engine control unit) -  
malfunction and warning messages ..................... 235  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE (several systems) -  
malfunction and warning messages ..................... 235  
Display illumination ........................................................85  
Doors ..................................................................................34  
Drinking and driving .................................................... 205  
Drive sensibly - save fuel ............................................. 205  
Driving instructions ..................................................... 205  
Driving off ...................................................................... 207  
Via engine oil level indicator ...................................112  
Via oil dipstick ...........................................................256  
Child restraint .............................................. 58, 63, 64, 74  
Cleaning and care of the vehicle .................................302  
Clock, setting ..................................................................106  
COMAND, radio and telephone ...................................178  
Combination switch .......................................................117  
Consumer information ..................................................323  
Control and operation of radio transmitters .............178  
COOLANT (coolant level) -  
malfunction and warning messages ......................240  
Coolant level  
Adding coolant ..........................................................258  
Checking ....................................................................257  
Index  
327  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Index  
328  
Engine oil consumption ................................................ 113  
Engine oil level  
Checking ............................................................ 112, 256  
Warning ..................................................................... 244  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL - malfunction  
and warning messages ............................................ 244  
Engine oil level indicator .............................................. 112  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL NOT WHEN ENGINE ON  
E
ELEC. STABIL. PROG. - malfunction  
and warning messages ............................................245  
Electronic main key .........................................................25  
Changing batteries ...................................................288  
Synchronizing remote control ................................290  
Electronic stability program (ESP)  
Control switch ...........................................................222  
Malfunction and warning messages ......................245  
Malfunction indicator lamp .....................................231  
Synchronizing ...........................................................221  
Warning lamp ............................................................231  
Emergency call  
See Tele Aid ...............................................................182  
Emergency tensioning retractor (ETR) .........................65  
Emergency trunk lid release button ............................. 41  
Emergency unlocking in case of accident ...................37  
Emission control ............................................................ 181  
Emission control label .................................................. 312  
Engine compartment .....................................................254  
(measuring) - multifunction indicator ................... 113  
Engine oils ...................................................................... 319  
Capacities ...................................................................317  
ESP (Electronic stability program) ....210, 212, 220, 278  
Control switch .......................................................... 222  
Malfunction and warning messages ..................... 245  
Malfunction indicator lamp .....................................231  
Synchronizing ...........................................................221  
Warning lamp ............................................................231  
Exterior lamp malfunction  
and warning message .............................................. 242  
Exterior lamp switch ..................................................... 114  
Exterior lamps ............................................................... 280  
Adjusting headlamp aim ......................................... 285  
Fog lamps ................................................................... 114  
Headlamps ...................... 114, 242, 243, 281, 285, 305  
Low and high beam ...........................................117, 282  
Parking lamps ................................................... 114, 282  
ENGINE FAN - malfunction  
and warning messages ............................................239  
Engine malfunction  
CHECK ENGINE malfunction indicator lamp .......228  
Engine oil additives ....................................................... 319  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Replacing bulbs .........................................................280  
Side marker lamp, front ...........................................284  
Standing lamps ..................................................114, 282  
Taillamp assemblies .................................................283  
Turn signal lamp ............................................... 117, 282  
G
Garage door opener .......................................................158  
Gasoline  
Additives .....................................................................321  
Fuel requirements ................................................... 320  
Premium unleaded .................................................. 320  
General notes on the central locking system ..............27  
Glove box ......................................................................... 151  
F
First aid kit .....................................................................250  
Flexible service system (FSS) ......................................109  
Fuel  
Gasoline additives ....................................................321  
Premium unleaded gasoline ..................180, 318, 320  
Fuel cap placement warning ........................................230  
Fuel filler flap  
Manual release ..........................................................298  
Fuel requirements .........................................................320  
Fuel reserve warning ....................................................230  
Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc. - capacities ............... 317  
Fuses, electrical .............................................................252  
H
Hazard warning flasher switch ................................... 119  
Head restraints  
Front ..............................................................................51  
Rear ...............................................................................52  
Removal ........................................................................51  
Headlamp cleaning system ........................................... 116  
Headlights ....................................................................... 114  
Heated seats ......................................................................56  
Hood ................................................................................ 254  
Index  
329  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Index  
330  
I
L
Identification labels ........................................................311  
Illuminated vanity mirrors ...........................................150  
Indicator lamps in the instrument cluster ...................84  
Individual settings .........................................................106  
Infant and child restraint systems ................................ 74  
Information call  
See Tele Aid ...............................................................182  
Instrument cluster ...........................................................82  
Activating display .......................................................85  
Indicator lamps ...........................................................84  
Instrument lamps ............................................................85  
Instruments and controls ............................................... 18  
Interior  
Lamps, exterior  
Fog lamps ................................................................... 114  
Headlamp, adjusting ................................................ 285  
Headlamps ...................... 114, 242, 243, 281, 285, 305  
Low and high beam ...........................................117, 282  
Parking lamps ................................................... 114, 282  
Replacing bulbs ........................................................ 280  
Side marker lamp, front .......................................... 284  
Standing lamps ................................................. 114, 282  
Taillamp assemblies ........................................ 114, 283  
Turn signal lamps .............................................117, 282  
Layout of poly-V-belt drive ............................................312  
LIGHT SENSOR - malfunction  
and warning messages ............................................ 243  
General notes ............................................................. 151  
Interior lighting .............................................................149  
Lighter .............................................................................155  
LIGHTING SYSTEM - malfunction  
and warning messages ............................................ 242  
Limp home mode (Automatic transmission) ............ 203  
Locking and unlocking ....................................................30  
Low engine coolant level warning .............................. 240  
Luggage cover ................................................................ 250  
J
Jump starting ..................................................................274  
K
Keys, vehicle .....................................................................24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Malfunction message memory ....................................104  
Manual operation of soft top ........................................291  
Mechanical keys ...............................................................33  
Memory  
M
Maintenance ...................................................................179  
Malfunction and indicator lamps  
in the instrument cluster .........................................228  
Malfunction and warning messages ...........................234  
ABS-SYSTEM .............................................................237  
BATTERY/ALTERNATOR ..........................................236  
BRAKE FLUID ............................................................238  
BRAKE LINING WEAR .............................................238  
COOLANT (coolant level) .........................................240  
COOLANT TEMP. (coolant temperature) ...............241  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE (engine control unit) .........235  
DISPLAY DEFECTIVE (several systems) ...............235  
ELEC. STABIL. PROG. ...............................................245  
ENGINE FAN ..............................................................239  
ENGINE OIL LEVEL ..................................................244  
LIGHT SENSOR .........................................................243  
LIGHTING SYSTEM ...................................................242  
PARKING BRAKE ......................................................239  
REMOVE KEY ............................................................245  
STEER. WHEEL ADJUST. .........................................243  
TELE AID ....................................................................247  
WASHER FLUID ........................................................246  
Recalling ................................................................ 49, 79  
Storing ...........................................................................48  
Mirror, exterior, adjusting ..............................................78  
Mirror, exterior, rear view ..............................................78  
Mirror, inside, rear view .................................................77  
Multicontour seat .............................................................55  
Multifunction display ......................................................88  
Engine oil level indicator ...........................................92  
FSS (Flexible service system) ...................................92  
Setting the audio volume .........................................108  
Trip and main odometer ............................................92  
Vehicle speed ...............................................................92  
Multifunction steering wheel .........................................88  
N
Navigation system - Multifunction display ................ 101  
Night security illumination .......................................... 115  
Index  
331  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Index  
332  
O
R
On-board diagnostic system .........................................228  
Operator’s Manual ............................................................. 8  
Outside temperature indicator ......................................86  
Overhead control panel ................................................... 21  
Radio transmitters .........................................................178  
Rain sensor ..................................................................... 118  
Rear view mirrors  
Exterior .........................................................................78  
Inside ............................................................................77  
Rear window defroster ..................................................124  
Remote control .................................................................28  
Battery replacement ................................................ 288  
REMOVE KEY - malfunction  
and warning messages ............................................ 245  
Replacing bulbs ............................................................. 280  
Replacing wiper blade insert ...................................... 299  
Reporting Safety Defects ................................................. 15  
Reserve key .......................................................................26  
Residual engine heat utilization (REST) ....................125  
Roadside assistance .........................................................10  
Roadside assistance call  
P
Panic button ......................................................................33  
Parcel net in front passenger footwell .......................156  
Parking ............................................................................207  
Parking brake ..................... 154, 194, 204, 207, 229, 266  
PARKING BRAKE - malfunction  
and warning messages ............................................239  
Power assistance ............................................................206  
Power seats, front ............................................................45  
Backrest ........................................................................54  
Power windows ...............................................................146  
Express opening and closing ..................................147  
Opening and closing ..................................................32  
Operated with soft top switch .................................148  
Synchronizing ...........................................................147  
Problems with your vehicle ........................................... 14  
Product information .......................................................... 7  
See Tele Aid ...............................................................182  
Roll bar  
Switch ...........................................................................52  
Warning lamp ........................................................... 233  
Roller blind  
Horizontal ................................................................... 174  
Vertical ........................................................................175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Spare parts service ........................................................310  
Spare wheel ...........................................................260, 264  
Special settings (Automatic climate control) ............123  
SRS indicator lamp ....................................................... 230  
SRS malfunction ...............................................................67  
Start lock-out .....................................................................27  
Starting and turning off the engine ............................194  
S
Safety guidelines for the seat belt, emergency  
tensioning retractor and airbag ................................72  
Seat belts ...........................................................................58  
Fastening ......................................................................60  
Seat belt nonusage warning system ........................59  
Unfastening .................................................................. 61  
STEER. WHEEL ADJUST. - malfunction  
and warning messages ............................................ 243  
Seat belts and supplemental  
Steering column, adjustable ........................................... 76  
Steering lock ...................................................................192  
Storage compartment  
restraint system (SRS) ................................................58  
Service indicator  
See Flexible service system (FSS) ..........................109  
Setting the audio volume ..............................................108  
Shelf below rear window ..............................................250  
Side marker lamp ..........................................................284  
Snow chains .................................................................... 210  
Soft top ............................................................................162  
Emergency operation ...............................................291  
Lowering .....................................................................164  
Raising ........................................................................ 166  
SOS-call  
Trunk floor ................................................................ 260  
Storage compartments  
Center console ...........................................................152  
Glove box ....................................................................151  
Storage compartments, armrest  
and cup holder ........................................................... 151  
Stowing things in the vehicle ..................................... 250  
Sun visors ........................................................................150  
Supplemental restraint system (SRS) ...........................65  
Synchronizing remote control .................................... 290  
See Tele Aid ...............................................................182  
Index  
333  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
data  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Car care  
Index  
Index  
334  
The first 1 000 miles .....................................................179  
Tire inflation pressure ..................................................271  
Tire speed rating ............................................................210  
Tire traction ................................................................... 209  
Tires ................................................................................ 323  
Driving instructions ................................................ 208  
Rims and tires ........................................................... 314  
Rotating wheels ........................................................ 263  
Tire inflation pressure .............................................271  
Tire replacement ...................................................... 262  
Winter driving instructions ..................................... 211  
Tow-away alarm ................................................................44  
Towing the vehicle .........................................................276  
Transmission ..................................................................195  
Transmission selector lever,  
manually unlocking ................................................. 279  
Traveling abroad ............................................................213  
Trip computer .................................................................102  
Trip odometer ...................................................................87  
Trunk .................................................................................38  
Opening ........................................................................31  
Release switch .............................................................40  
Separately locked ........................................................38  
Trunk lamp .................................................................... 299  
T
Tachometer .......................................................................87  
Technical data ................................................................ 313  
Electrical system ....................................................... 315  
Main dimensions ...................................................... 316  
Rims and tires ........................................................... 314  
Weights ....................................................................... 315  
Tele Aid ...........................................................................182  
Emergency calls ........................................................183  
Information ................................................................187  
Initiating an emergency call manually .................185  
Roadside Assistance .................................................186  
TELE AID - malfunction  
and warning messages ............................................247  
Telephone ..........................................................................96  
General notes .............................................................157  
Incoming call .............................................................100  
Redialing ......................................................................98  
Telephone book ...........................................................96  
Telephones and two-way radios ...................................178  
Telescoping steering column  
Adjusting ...................................................................... 76  
Indicator lamp ...........................................................232  
Telescoping steering column - malfunction  
and warning messages ............................................243  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Trunk lid  
Emergency release ..................................................... 41  
Release switch .............................................................40  
Turn signal failure ..........................................................117  
Turn signals .....................................................................117  
W
Warranty coverage ......................................................... 310  
WASHER FLUID (headlamp cleaning system) -  
malfunction and warning messages ..................... 246  
Washing the vehicle ..................................................... 304  
What you should know at the gas station ................. 224  
Wheels ............................................................................ 262  
Light alloy wheels .................................................... 305  
Rims and tires ........................................................... 314  
Wheels, changing ..................................................... 266  
Where to find it ................................................................ 13  
Wind screen ....................................................................170  
Windshield washer/headlamp cleaning system  
Refilling ..................................................................... 259  
Winter driving ................................................................212  
Winter driving instructions .......................................... 211  
Wiper blade  
V
Vanity mirrors ................................................................150  
Vehicle jack .....................................................................261  
Vehicle tools ....................................................................260  
Replacing insert ....................................................... 299  
Index  
335  
Instruments  
and controls  
Instrument  
cluster display  
Technical  
Operation  
Driving  
Practical hints  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DoCwnalroacda.re  
Index  
data  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Literature  
Your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center has trained technicians and original Mercedes-Benz parts to service your  
vehicle properly. For expert advice and quality service, see your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.  
If your are interested in obtaining service literature for your vehicle, please contact your authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center. We consider this the best way for you to obtain accurate information for your vehicle.  
For further information you can find us on the Mercedes-Benz web-site www.mbusa.com.  
Warning!  
To help avoid personal injury, be extremely careful when performing any service work or repairs. Improper  
or incomplete service or the use of incorrect or inappropriate parts or materials may damage the vehicle or its  
equipment, which may in turn result in personal injury.  
If you have any question about carrying out some service, turn to the advice of an authorized Mercedes-Benz  
Center.  
We reserve the right to modify the technical details of the vehicle as given in the data and illustrations of this  
Operator’s Manual. Reprinting, translation and copying, even of excerpts, is not permitted without our prior  
authorization in writing.  
Title illustration no. P00.00-2729-26  
Press time 10/31/00  
MBUSA/TI  
Printed in the U.S.A.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Order No. 6515 1252 13 Part No. 208 584 87 83 USA Edition B 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Laser DVR STB HDM2000 User Manual
Learning Resources Games Buy It Right User Manual
Lightolier Indoor Furnishings VPA2G12PP317 User Manual
Lincoln Automobile 2007 Navigator User Manual
Lindy Switch 25030 User Manual
Linksys Switch SGE2010 User Manual
Makita Trimmer JS8000 User Manual
Melissa Coffeemaker 645 085 User Manual
Memorex MP3 Docking Station 749720 00966 4 User Manual
Meyer Sound Speaker CQTM Series User Manual